]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git/blob - ld/ld.texi
Automatic date update in version.in
[thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git] / ld / ld.texi
1 \input texinfo
2 @setfilename ld.info
3 @c Copyright (C) 1991-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 @syncodeindex ky cp
5 @c man begin INCLUDE
6 @include configdoc.texi
7 @c (configdoc.texi is generated by the Makefile)
8 @include bfdver.texi
9 @c man end
10
11 @c @smallbook
12
13 @macro gcctabopt{body}
14 @code{\body\}
15 @end macro
16
17 @c man begin NAME
18 @ifset man
19 @c Configure for the generation of man pages
20 @set UsesEnvVars
21 @set GENERIC
22 @set ARM
23 @set C6X
24 @set CSKY
25 @set H8300
26 @set HPPA
27 @set M68HC11
28 @set M68K
29 @set MIPS
30 @set MMIX
31 @set MSP430
32 @set NDS32
33 @set NIOSII
34 @set PDP11
35 @set POWERPC
36 @set POWERPC64
37 @set Renesas
38 @set S/390
39 @set SPU
40 @set TICOFF
41 @set WIN32
42 @set XTENSA
43 @end ifset
44 @c man end
45
46 @ifnottex
47 @dircategory Software development
48 @direntry
49 * Ld: (ld). The GNU linker.
50 @end direntry
51 @end ifnottex
52
53 @copying
54 This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker LD
55 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
56 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
57 @end ifset
58 version @value{VERSION}.
59
60 Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
61
62 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
63 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
64 or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
65 with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
66 Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
67 section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
68 @end copying
69 @iftex
70 @finalout
71 @setchapternewpage odd
72 @settitle The GNU linker
73 @titlepage
74 @title The GNU linker
75 @sp 1
76 @subtitle @code{ld}
77 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
78 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
79 @end ifset
80 @subtitle Version @value{VERSION}
81 @author Steve Chamberlain
82 @author Ian Lance Taylor
83 @page
84
85 @tex
86 {\parskip=0pt
87 \hfill Red Hat Inc\par
88 \hfill nickc\@credhat.com, doc\@redhat.com\par
89 \hfill {\it The GNU linker}\par
90 \hfill Edited by Jeffrey Osier (jeffrey\@cygnus.com)\par
91 }
92 \global\parindent=0pt % Steve likes it this way.
93 @end tex
94
95 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
96 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
97 Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
98
99 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
100 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
101 or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
102 with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
103 Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
104 section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
105 @c man end
106
107 @end titlepage
108 @end iftex
109 @contents
110 @c FIXME: Talk about importance of *order* of args, cmds to linker!
111
112 @ifnottex
113 @node Top
114 @top LD
115 This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker ld
116 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
117 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
118 @end ifset
119 version @value{VERSION}.
120
121 This document is distributed under the terms of the GNU Free
122 Documentation License version 1.3. A copy of the license is included
123 in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
124
125 @menu
126 * Overview:: Overview
127 * Invocation:: Invocation
128 * Scripts:: Linker Scripts
129 @ifset GENERIC
130 * Machine Dependent:: Machine Dependent Features
131 @end ifset
132 @ifclear GENERIC
133 @ifset H8300
134 * H8/300:: ld and the H8/300
135 @end ifset
136 @ifset Renesas
137 * Renesas:: ld and other Renesas micros
138 @end ifset
139 @ifset ARM
140 * ARM:: ld and the ARM family
141 @end ifset
142 @ifset M68HC11
143 * M68HC11/68HC12:: ld and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
144 @end ifset
145 @ifset HPPA
146 * HPPA ELF32:: ld and HPPA 32-bit ELF
147 @end ifset
148 @ifset M68K
149 * M68K:: ld and Motorola 68K family
150 @end ifset
151 @ifset MIPS
152 * MIPS:: ld and MIPS family
153 @end ifset
154 @ifset POWERPC
155 * PowerPC ELF32:: ld and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
156 @end ifset
157 @ifset POWERPC64
158 * PowerPC64 ELF64:: ld and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
159 @end ifset
160 @ifset S/390
161 * S/390 ELF:: ld and S/390 ELF Support
162 @end ifset
163 @ifset SPU
164 * SPU ELF:: ld and SPU ELF Support
165 @end ifset
166 @ifset TICOFF
167 * TI COFF:: ld and the TI COFF
168 @end ifset
169 @ifset WIN32
170 * Win32:: ld and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
171 @end ifset
172 @ifset XTENSA
173 * Xtensa:: ld and Xtensa Processors
174 @end ifset
175 @end ifclear
176 @ifclear SingleFormat
177 * BFD:: BFD
178 @end ifclear
179 @c Following blank line required for remaining bug in makeinfo conds/menus
180
181 * Reporting Bugs:: Reporting Bugs
182 * MRI:: MRI Compatible Script Files
183 * GNU Free Documentation License:: GNU Free Documentation License
184 * LD Index:: LD Index
185 @end menu
186 @end ifnottex
187
188 @node Overview
189 @chapter Overview
190
191 @cindex @sc{gnu} linker
192 @cindex what is this?
193
194 @ifset man
195 @c man begin SYNOPSIS
196 ld [@b{options}] @var{objfile} @dots{}
197 @c man end
198
199 @c man begin SEEALSO
200 ar(1), nm(1), objcopy(1), objdump(1), readelf(1) and
201 the Info entries for @file{binutils} and
202 @file{ld}.
203 @c man end
204 @end ifset
205
206 @c man begin DESCRIPTION
207
208 @command{ld} combines a number of object and archive files, relocates
209 their data and ties up symbol references. Usually the last step in
210 compiling a program is to run @command{ld}.
211
212 @command{ld} accepts Linker Command Language files written in
213 a superset of AT&T's Link Editor Command Language syntax,
214 to provide explicit and total control over the linking process.
215
216 @ifset man
217 @c For the man only
218 This man page does not describe the command language; see the
219 @command{ld} entry in @code{info} for full details on the command
220 language and on other aspects of the GNU linker.
221 @end ifset
222
223 @ifclear SingleFormat
224 This version of @command{ld} uses the general purpose BFD libraries
225 to operate on object files. This allows @command{ld} to read, combine, and
226 write object files in many different formats---for example, COFF or
227 @code{a.out}. Different formats may be linked together to produce any
228 available kind of object file. @xref{BFD}, for more information.
229 @end ifclear
230
231 Aside from its flexibility, the @sc{gnu} linker is more helpful than other
232 linkers in providing diagnostic information. Many linkers abandon
233 execution immediately upon encountering an error; whenever possible,
234 @command{ld} continues executing, allowing you to identify other errors
235 (or, in some cases, to get an output file in spite of the error).
236
237 @c man end
238
239 @node Invocation
240 @chapter Invocation
241
242 @c man begin DESCRIPTION
243
244 The @sc{gnu} linker @command{ld} is meant to cover a broad range of situations,
245 and to be as compatible as possible with other linkers. As a result,
246 you have many choices to control its behavior.
247
248 @c man end
249
250 @ifset UsesEnvVars
251 @menu
252 * Options:: Command-line Options
253 * Environment:: Environment Variables
254 @end menu
255
256 @node Options
257 @section Command-line Options
258 @end ifset
259
260 @cindex command line
261 @cindex options
262
263 @c man begin OPTIONS
264
265 The linker supports a plethora of command-line options, but in actual
266 practice few of them are used in any particular context.
267 @cindex standard Unix system
268 For instance, a frequent use of @command{ld} is to link standard Unix
269 object files on a standard, supported Unix system. On such a system, to
270 link a file @code{hello.o}:
271
272 @smallexample
273 ld -o @var{output} /lib/crt0.o hello.o -lc
274 @end smallexample
275
276 This tells @command{ld} to produce a file called @var{output} as the
277 result of linking the file @code{/lib/crt0.o} with @code{hello.o} and
278 the library @code{libc.a}, which will come from the standard search
279 directories. (See the discussion of the @samp{-l} option below.)
280
281 Some of the command-line options to @command{ld} may be specified at any
282 point in the command line. However, options which refer to files, such
283 as @samp{-l} or @samp{-T}, cause the file to be read at the point at
284 which the option appears in the command line, relative to the object
285 files and other file options. Repeating non-file options with a
286 different argument will either have no further effect, or override prior
287 occurrences (those further to the left on the command line) of that
288 option. Options which may be meaningfully specified more than once are
289 noted in the descriptions below.
290
291 @cindex object files
292 Non-option arguments are object files or archives which are to be linked
293 together. They may follow, precede, or be mixed in with command-line
294 options, except that an object file argument may not be placed between
295 an option and its argument.
296
297 Usually the linker is invoked with at least one object file, but you can
298 specify other forms of binary input files using @samp{-l}, @samp{-R},
299 and the script command language. If @emph{no} binary input files at all
300 are specified, the linker does not produce any output, and issues the
301 message @samp{No input files}.
302
303 If the linker cannot recognize the format of an object file, it will
304 assume that it is a linker script. A script specified in this way
305 augments the main linker script used for the link (either the default
306 linker script or the one specified by using @samp{-T}). This feature
307 permits the linker to link against a file which appears to be an object
308 or an archive, but actually merely defines some symbol values, or uses
309 @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} to load other objects. Specifying a
310 script in this way merely augments the main linker script, with the
311 extra commands placed after the main script; use the @samp{-T} option
312 to replace the default linker script entirely, but note the effect of
313 the @code{INSERT} command. @xref{Scripts}.
314
315 For options whose names are a single letter,
316 option arguments must either follow the option letter without intervening
317 whitespace, or be given as separate arguments immediately following the
318 option that requires them.
319
320 For options whose names are multiple letters, either one dash or two can
321 precede the option name; for example, @samp{-trace-symbol} and
322 @samp{--trace-symbol} are equivalent. Note---there is one exception to
323 this rule. Multiple letter options that start with a lower case 'o' can
324 only be preceded by two dashes. This is to reduce confusion with the
325 @samp{-o} option. So for example @samp{-omagic} sets the output file
326 name to @samp{magic} whereas @samp{--omagic} sets the NMAGIC flag on the
327 output.
328
329 Arguments to multiple-letter options must either be separated from the
330 option name by an equals sign, or be given as separate arguments
331 immediately following the option that requires them. For example,
332 @samp{--trace-symbol foo} and @samp{--trace-symbol=foo} are equivalent.
333 Unique abbreviations of the names of multiple-letter options are
334 accepted.
335
336 Note---if the linker is being invoked indirectly, via a compiler driver
337 (e.g. @samp{gcc}) then all the linker command-line options should be
338 prefixed by @samp{-Wl,} (or whatever is appropriate for the particular
339 compiler driver) like this:
340
341 @smallexample
342 gcc -Wl,--start-group foo.o bar.o -Wl,--end-group
343 @end smallexample
344
345 This is important, because otherwise the compiler driver program may
346 silently drop the linker options, resulting in a bad link. Confusion
347 may also arise when passing options that require values through a
348 driver, as the use of a space between option and argument acts as
349 a separator, and causes the driver to pass only the option to the linker
350 and the argument to the compiler. In this case, it is simplest to use
351 the joined forms of both single- and multiple-letter options, such as:
352
353 @smallexample
354 gcc foo.o bar.o -Wl,-eENTRY -Wl,-Map=a.map
355 @end smallexample
356
357 Here is a table of the generic command-line switches accepted by the GNU
358 linker:
359
360 @table @gcctabopt
361 @include at-file.texi
362
363 @kindex -a @var{keyword}
364 @item -a @var{keyword}
365 This option is supported for HP/UX compatibility. The @var{keyword}
366 argument must be one of the strings @samp{archive}, @samp{shared}, or
367 @samp{default}. @samp{-aarchive} is functionally equivalent to
368 @samp{-Bstatic}, and the other two keywords are functionally equivalent
369 to @samp{-Bdynamic}. This option may be used any number of times.
370
371 @kindex --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
372 @item --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
373 Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_AUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
374 @var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
375 specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_AUDIT}
376 will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. If the linker
377 finds an object with an audit entry while searching for shared libraries,
378 it will add a corresponding @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry in the output file.
379 This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit
380 interface.
381
382 @ifclear SingleFormat
383 @cindex binary input format
384 @kindex -b @var{format}
385 @kindex --format=@var{format}
386 @cindex input format
387 @cindex input format
388 @item -b @var{input-format}
389 @itemx --format=@var{input-format}
390 @command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
391 file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
392 @samp{-b} option to specify the binary format for input object files
393 that follow this option on the command line. Even when @command{ld} is
394 configured to support alternative object formats, you don't usually need
395 to specify this, as @command{ld} should be configured to expect as a
396 default input format the most usual format on each machine.
397 @var{input-format} is a text string, the name of a particular format
398 supported by the BFD libraries. (You can list the available binary
399 formats with @samp{objdump -i}.)
400 @xref{BFD}.
401
402 You may want to use this option if you are linking files with an unusual
403 binary format. You can also use @samp{-b} to switch formats explicitly (when
404 linking object files of different formats), by including
405 @samp{-b @var{input-format}} before each group of object files in a
406 particular format.
407
408 The default format is taken from the environment variable
409 @code{GNUTARGET}.
410 @ifset UsesEnvVars
411 @xref{Environment}.
412 @end ifset
413 You can also define the input format from a script, using the command
414 @code{TARGET};
415 @ifclear man
416 see @ref{Format Commands}.
417 @end ifclear
418 @end ifclear
419
420 @kindex -c @var{MRI-cmdfile}
421 @kindex --mri-script=@var{MRI-cmdfile}
422 @cindex compatibility, MRI
423 @item -c @var{MRI-commandfile}
424 @itemx --mri-script=@var{MRI-commandfile}
425 For compatibility with linkers produced by MRI, @command{ld} accepts script
426 files written in an alternate, restricted command language, described in
427 @ifclear man
428 @ref{MRI,,MRI Compatible Script Files}.
429 @end ifclear
430 @ifset man
431 the MRI Compatible Script Files section of GNU ld documentation.
432 @end ifset
433 Introduce MRI script files with
434 the option @samp{-c}; use the @samp{-T} option to run linker
435 scripts written in the general-purpose @command{ld} scripting language.
436 If @var{MRI-cmdfile} does not exist, @command{ld} looks for it in the directories
437 specified by any @samp{-L} options.
438
439 @cindex common allocation
440 @kindex -d
441 @kindex -dc
442 @kindex -dp
443 @item -d
444 @itemx -dc
445 @itemx -dp
446 These three options are equivalent; multiple forms are supported for
447 compatibility with other linkers. They assign space to common symbols
448 even if a relocatable output file is specified (with @samp{-r}). The
449 script command @code{FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
450 @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
451
452 @kindex --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
453 @kindex -P @var{AUDITLIB}
454 @item --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
455 @itemx -P @var{AUDITLIB}
456 Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
457 @var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
458 specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_DEPAUDIT}
459 will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. This
460 option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit interface.
461 The -P option is provided for Solaris compatibility.
462
463 @kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions
464 @item --enable-non-contiguous-regions
465 This option avoids generating an error if an input section does not
466 fit a matching output section. The linker tries to allocate the input
467 section to subseque nt matching output sections, and generates an
468 error only if no output section is large enough. This is useful when
469 several non-contiguous memory regions are available and the input
470 section does not require a particular one. The order in which input
471 sections are evaluated does not change, for instance:
472
473 @smallexample
474 MEMORY @{
475 MEM1 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x14
476 MEM2 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x40
477 MEM3 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x2000, LENGTH = 0x40
478 @}
479 SECTIONS @{
480 mem1 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM1
481 mem2 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
482 mem3 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
483 @}
484
485 with input sections:
486 .data.1: size 8
487 .data.2: size 0x10
488 .data.3: size 4
489
490 results in .data.1 affected to mem1, and .data.2 and .data.3
491 affected to mem2, even though .data.3 would fit in mem3.
492 @end smallexample
493
494 This option is incompatible with INSERT statements because it changes
495 the way input sections are mapped to output sections.
496
497 @kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
498 @item --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
499 This option enables warnings when
500 @code{--enable-non-contiguous-regions} allows possibly unexpected
501 matches in sections mapping, potentially leading to silently
502 discarding a section instead of failing because it does not fit any
503 output region.
504
505 @cindex entry point, from command line
506 @kindex -e @var{entry}
507 @kindex --entry=@var{entry}
508 @item -e @var{entry}
509 @itemx --entry=@var{entry}
510 Use @var{entry} as the explicit symbol for beginning execution of your
511 program, rather than the default entry point. If there is no symbol
512 named @var{entry}, the linker will try to parse @var{entry} as a number,
513 and use that as the entry address (the number will be interpreted in
514 base 10; you may use a leading @samp{0x} for base 16, or a leading
515 @samp{0} for base 8). @xref{Entry Point}, for a discussion of defaults
516 and other ways of specifying the entry point.
517
518 @kindex --exclude-libs
519 @item --exclude-libs @var{lib},@var{lib},...
520 Specifies a list of archive libraries from which symbols should not be automatically
521 exported. The library names may be delimited by commas or colons. Specifying
522 @code{--exclude-libs ALL} excludes symbols in all archive libraries from
523 automatic export. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted
524 port of the linker and for ELF targeted ports. For i386 PE, symbols
525 explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported, regardless of this
526 option. For ELF targeted ports, symbols affected by this option will
527 be treated as hidden.
528
529 @kindex --exclude-modules-for-implib
530 @item --exclude-modules-for-implib @var{module},@var{module},...
531 Specifies a list of object files or archive members, from which symbols
532 should not be automatically exported, but which should be copied wholesale
533 into the import library being generated during the link. The module names
534 may be delimited by commas or colons, and must match exactly the filenames
535 used by @command{ld} to open the files; for archive members, this is simply
536 the member name, but for object files the name listed must include and
537 match precisely any path used to specify the input file on the linker's
538 command-line. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted port
539 of the linker. Symbols explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported,
540 regardless of this option.
541
542 @cindex dynamic symbol table
543 @kindex -E
544 @kindex --export-dynamic
545 @kindex --no-export-dynamic
546 @item -E
547 @itemx --export-dynamic
548 @itemx --no-export-dynamic
549 When creating a dynamically linked executable, using the @option{-E}
550 option or the @option{--export-dynamic} option causes the linker to add
551 all symbols to the dynamic symbol table. The dynamic symbol table is the
552 set of symbols which are visible from dynamic objects at run time.
553
554 If you do not use either of these options (or use the
555 @option{--no-export-dynamic} option to restore the default behavior), the
556 dynamic symbol table will normally contain only those symbols which are
557 referenced by some dynamic object mentioned in the link.
558
559 If you use @code{dlopen} to load a dynamic object which needs to refer
560 back to the symbols defined by the program, rather than some other
561 dynamic object, then you will probably need to use this option when
562 linking the program itself.
563
564 You can also use the dynamic list to control what symbols should
565 be added to the dynamic symbol table if the output format supports it.
566 See the description of @samp{--dynamic-list}.
567
568 Note that this option is specific to ELF targeted ports. PE targets
569 support a similar function to export all symbols from a DLL or EXE; see
570 the description of @samp{--export-all-symbols} below.
571
572 @kindex --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
573 @cindex export dynamic symbol
574 @item --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
575 When creating a dynamically linked executable, symbols matching
576 @var{glob} will be added to the dynamic symbol table. When creating a
577 shared library, references to symbols matching @var{glob} will not be
578 bound to the definitions within the shared library. This option is a
579 no-op when creating a shared library and @samp{-Bsymbolic} or
580 @samp{--dynamic-list} are not specified. This option is only meaningful
581 on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
582
583 @kindex --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
584 @cindex export dynamic symbol list
585 @item --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
586 Specify a @samp{--export-dynamic-symbol} for each pattern in the file.
587 The format of the file is the same as the version node without
588 scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
589
590 @ifclear SingleFormat
591 @cindex big-endian objects
592 @cindex endianness
593 @kindex -EB
594 @item -EB
595 Link big-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
596
597 @cindex little-endian objects
598 @kindex -EL
599 @item -EL
600 Link little-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
601 @end ifclear
602
603 @kindex -f @var{name}
604 @kindex --auxiliary=@var{name}
605 @item -f @var{name}
606 @itemx --auxiliary=@var{name}
607 When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_AUXILIARY field
608 to the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol
609 table of the shared object should be used as an auxiliary filter on the
610 symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
611
612 If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
613 run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_AUXILIARY field. If
614 the dynamic linker resolves any symbols from the filter object, it will
615 first check whether there is a definition in the shared object
616 @var{name}. If there is one, it will be used instead of the definition
617 in the filter object. The shared object @var{name} need not exist.
618 Thus the shared object @var{name} may be used to provide an alternative
619 implementation of certain functions, perhaps for debugging or for
620 machine-specific performance.
621
622 This option may be specified more than once. The DT_AUXILIARY entries
623 will be created in the order in which they appear on the command line.
624
625 @kindex -F @var{name}
626 @kindex --filter=@var{name}
627 @item -F @var{name}
628 @itemx --filter=@var{name}
629 When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_FILTER field to
630 the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol table
631 of the shared object which is being created should be used as a filter
632 on the symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
633
634 If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
635 run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_FILTER field. The
636 dynamic linker will resolve symbols according to the symbol table of the
637 filter object as usual, but it will actually link to the definitions
638 found in the shared object @var{name}. Thus the filter object can be
639 used to select a subset of the symbols provided by the object
640 @var{name}.
641
642 Some older linkers used the @option{-F} option throughout a compilation
643 toolchain for specifying object-file format for both input and output
644 object files.
645 @ifclear SingleFormat
646 The @sc{gnu} linker uses other mechanisms for this purpose: the
647 @option{-b}, @option{--format}, @option{--oformat} options, the
648 @code{TARGET} command in linker scripts, and the @code{GNUTARGET}
649 environment variable.
650 @end ifclear
651 The @sc{gnu} linker will ignore the @option{-F} option when not
652 creating an ELF shared object.
653
654 @cindex finalization function
655 @kindex -fini=@var{name}
656 @item -fini=@var{name}
657 When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
658 executable or shared object is unloaded, by setting DT_FINI to the
659 address of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_fini} as
660 the function to call.
661
662 @kindex -g
663 @item -g
664 Ignored. Provided for compatibility with other tools.
665
666 @kindex -G @var{value}
667 @kindex --gpsize=@var{value}
668 @cindex object size
669 @item -G @var{value}
670 @itemx --gpsize=@var{value}
671 Set the maximum size of objects to be optimized using the GP register to
672 @var{size}. This is only meaningful for object file formats such as
673 MIPS ELF that support putting large and small objects into different
674 sections. This is ignored for other object file formats.
675
676 @cindex runtime library name
677 @kindex -h @var{name}
678 @kindex -soname=@var{name}
679 @item -h @var{name}
680 @itemx -soname=@var{name}
681 When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_SONAME field to
682 the specified name. When an executable is linked with a shared object
683 which has a DT_SONAME field, then when the executable is run the dynamic
684 linker will attempt to load the shared object specified by the DT_SONAME
685 field rather than the using the file name given to the linker.
686
687 @kindex -i
688 @cindex incremental link
689 @item -i
690 Perform an incremental link (same as option @samp{-r}).
691
692 @cindex initialization function
693 @kindex -init=@var{name}
694 @item -init=@var{name}
695 When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
696 executable or shared object is loaded, by setting DT_INIT to the address
697 of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_init} as the
698 function to call.
699
700 @cindex archive files, from cmd line
701 @kindex -l @var{namespec}
702 @kindex --library=@var{namespec}
703 @item -l @var{namespec}
704 @itemx --library=@var{namespec}
705 Add the archive or object file specified by @var{namespec} to the
706 list of files to link. This option may be used any number of times.
707 If @var{namespec} is of the form @file{:@var{filename}}, @command{ld}
708 will search the library path for a file called @var{filename}, otherwise it
709 will search the library path for a file called @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}.
710
711 On systems which support shared libraries, @command{ld} may also search for
712 files other than @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. Specifically, on ELF
713 and SunOS systems, @command{ld} will search a directory for a library
714 called @file{lib@var{namespec}.so} before searching for one called
715 @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. (By convention, a @code{.so} extension
716 indicates a shared library.) Note that this behavior does not apply
717 to @file{:@var{filename}}, which always specifies a file called
718 @var{filename}.
719
720 The linker will search an archive only once, at the location where it is
721 specified on the command line. If the archive defines a symbol which
722 was undefined in some object which appeared before the archive on the
723 command line, the linker will include the appropriate file(s) from the
724 archive. However, an undefined symbol in an object appearing later on
725 the command line will not cause the linker to search the archive again.
726
727 See the @option{-(} option for a way to force the linker to search
728 archives multiple times.
729
730 You may list the same archive multiple times on the command line.
731
732 @ifset GENERIC
733 This type of archive searching is standard for Unix linkers. However,
734 if you are using @command{ld} on AIX, note that it is different from the
735 behaviour of the AIX linker.
736 @end ifset
737
738 @cindex search directory, from cmd line
739 @kindex -L @var{dir}
740 @kindex --library-path=@var{dir}
741 @item -L @var{searchdir}
742 @itemx --library-path=@var{searchdir}
743 Add path @var{searchdir} to the list of paths that @command{ld} will search
744 for archive libraries and @command{ld} control scripts. You may use this
745 option any number of times. The directories are searched in the order
746 in which they are specified on the command line. Directories specified
747 on the command line are searched before the default directories. All
748 @option{-L} options apply to all @option{-l} options, regardless of the
749 order in which the options appear. @option{-L} options do not affect
750 how @command{ld} searches for a linker script unless @option{-T}
751 option is specified.
752
753 If @var{searchdir} begins with @code{=} or @code{$SYSROOT}, then this
754 prefix will be replaced by the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, controlled by the
755 @samp{--sysroot} option, or specified when the linker is configured.
756
757 @ifset UsesEnvVars
758 The default set of paths searched (without being specified with
759 @samp{-L}) depends on which emulation mode @command{ld} is using, and in
760 some cases also on how it was configured. @xref{Environment}.
761 @end ifset
762
763 The paths can also be specified in a link script with the
764 @code{SEARCH_DIR} command. Directories specified this way are searched
765 at the point in which the linker script appears in the command line.
766
767 @cindex emulation
768 @kindex -m @var{emulation}
769 @item -m @var{emulation}
770 Emulate the @var{emulation} linker. You can list the available
771 emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options.
772
773 If the @samp{-m} option is not used, the emulation is taken from the
774 @code{LDEMULATION} environment variable, if that is defined.
775
776 Otherwise, the default emulation depends upon how the linker was
777 configured.
778
779 @cindex link map
780 @kindex -M
781 @kindex --print-map
782 @item -M
783 @itemx --print-map
784 Print a link map to the standard output. A link map provides
785 information about the link, including the following:
786
787 @itemize @bullet
788 @item
789 Where object files are mapped into memory.
790 @item
791 How common symbols are allocated.
792 @item
793 All archive members included in the link, with a mention of the symbol
794 which caused the archive member to be brought in.
795 @item
796 The values assigned to symbols.
797
798 Note - symbols whose values are computed by an expression which
799 involves a reference to a previous value of the same symbol may not
800 have correct result displayed in the link map. This is because the
801 linker discards intermediate results and only retains the final value
802 of an expression. Under such circumstances the linker will display
803 the final value enclosed by square brackets. Thus for example a
804 linker script containing:
805
806 @smallexample
807 foo = 1
808 foo = foo * 4
809 foo = foo + 8
810 @end smallexample
811
812 will produce the following output in the link map if the @option{-M}
813 option is used:
814
815 @smallexample
816 0x00000001 foo = 0x1
817 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo * 0x4)
818 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo + 0x8)
819 @end smallexample
820
821 See @ref{Expressions} for more information about expressions in linker
822 scripts.
823
824 @item
825 How GNU properties are merged.
826
827 When the linker merges input .note.gnu.property sections into one output
828 .note.gnu.property section, some properties are removed or updated.
829 These actions are reported in the link map. For example:
830
831 @smallexample
832 Removed property 0xc0000002 to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (not found)
833 @end smallexample
834
835 This indicates that property 0xc0000002 is removed from output when
836 merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose property 0xc0000002 value
837 is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, which doesn't have property 0xc0000002.
838
839 @smallexample
840 Updated property 0xc0010001 (0x1) to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (0x1)
841 @end smallexample
842
843 This indicates that property 0xc0010001 value is updated to 0x1 in output
844 when merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value
845 is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value is 0x1.
846 @end itemize
847
848 @cindex link map discarded
849 @kindex --print-map-discarded
850 @kindex --no-print-map-discarded
851 @item --print-map-discarded
852 @itemx --no-print-map-discarded
853 Print (or do not print) the list of discarded and garbage collected sections
854 in the link map. Enabled by default.
855
856 @kindex -n
857 @cindex read-only text
858 @cindex NMAGIC
859 @kindex --nmagic
860 @item -n
861 @itemx --nmagic
862 Turn off page alignment of sections, and disable linking against shared
863 libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
864 mark the output as @code{NMAGIC}.
865
866 @kindex -N
867 @kindex --omagic
868 @cindex read/write from cmd line
869 @cindex OMAGIC
870 @item -N
871 @itemx --omagic
872 Set the text and data sections to be readable and writable. Also, do
873 not page-align the data segment, and disable linking against shared
874 libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
875 mark the output as @code{OMAGIC}. Note: Although a writable text section
876 is allowed for PE-COFF targets, it does not conform to the format
877 specification published by Microsoft.
878
879 @kindex --no-omagic
880 @cindex OMAGIC
881 @item --no-omagic
882 This option negates most of the effects of the @option{-N} option. It
883 sets the text section to be read-only, and forces the data segment to
884 be page-aligned. Note - this option does not enable linking against
885 shared libraries. Use @option{-Bdynamic} for this.
886
887 @kindex -o @var{output}
888 @kindex --output=@var{output}
889 @cindex naming the output file
890 @item -o @var{output}
891 @itemx --output=@var{output}
892 Use @var{output} as the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; if this
893 option is not specified, the name @file{a.out} is used by default. The
894 script command @code{OUTPUT} can also specify the output file name.
895
896 @kindex --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
897 @cindex dependency file
898 @item --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
899 Write a @dfn{dependency file} to @var{depfile}. This file contains a rule
900 suitable for @code{make} describing the output file and all the input files
901 that were read to produce it. The output is similar to the compiler's
902 output with @samp{-M -MP} (@pxref{Preprocessor Options,, Options
903 Controlling the Preprocessor, gcc.info, Using the GNU Compiler
904 Collection}). Note that there is no option like the compiler's @samp{-MM},
905 to exclude ``system files'' (which is not a well-specified concept in the
906 linker, unlike ``system headers'' in the compiler). So the output from
907 @samp{--dependency-file} is always specific to the exact state of the
908 installation where it was produced, and should not be copied into
909 distributed makefiles without careful editing.
910
911 @kindex -O @var{level}
912 @cindex generating optimized output
913 @item -O @var{level}
914 If @var{level} is a numeric values greater than zero @command{ld} optimizes
915 the output. This might take significantly longer and therefore probably
916 should only be enabled for the final binary. At the moment this
917 option only affects ELF shared library generation. Future releases of
918 the linker may make more use of this option. Also currently there is
919 no difference in the linker's behaviour for different non-zero values
920 of this option. Again this may change with future releases.
921
922 @kindex -plugin @var{name}
923 @item -plugin @var{name}
924 Involve a plugin in the linking process. The @var{name} parameter is
925 the absolute filename of the plugin. Usually this parameter is
926 automatically added by the complier, when using link time
927 optimization, but users can also add their own plugins if they so
928 wish.
929
930 Note that the location of the compiler originated plugins is different
931 from the place where the @command{ar}, @command{nm} and
932 @command{ranlib} programs search for their plugins. In order for
933 those commands to make use of a compiler based plugin it must first be
934 copied into the @file{$@{libdir@}/bfd-plugins} directory. All gcc
935 based linker plugins are backward compatible, so it is sufficient to
936 just copy in the newest one.
937
938 @kindex --push-state
939 @cindex push state governing input file handling
940 @item --push-state
941 The @option{--push-state} allows to preserve the current state of the
942 flags which govern the input file handling so that they can all be
943 restored with one corresponding @option{--pop-state} option.
944
945 The option which are covered are: @option{-Bdynamic}, @option{-Bstatic},
946 @option{-dn}, @option{-dy}, @option{-call_shared}, @option{-non_shared},
947 @option{-static}, @option{-N}, @option{-n}, @option{--whole-archive},
948 @option{--no-whole-archive}, @option{-r}, @option{-Ur},
949 @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}, @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries},
950 @option{--as-needed}, @option{--no-as-needed}, and @option{-a}.
951
952 One target for this option are specifications for @file{pkg-config}. When
953 used with the @option{--libs} option all possibly needed libraries are
954 listed and then possibly linked with all the time. It is better to return
955 something as follows:
956
957 @smallexample
958 -Wl,--push-state,--as-needed -libone -libtwo -Wl,--pop-state
959 @end smallexample
960
961 @kindex --pop-state
962 @cindex pop state governing input file handling
963 @item --pop-state
964 Undoes the effect of --push-state, restores the previous values of the
965 flags governing input file handling.
966
967 @kindex -q
968 @kindex --emit-relocs
969 @cindex retain relocations in final executable
970 @item -q
971 @itemx --emit-relocs
972 Leave relocation sections and contents in fully linked executables.
973 Post link analysis and optimization tools may need this information in
974 order to perform correct modifications of executables. This results
975 in larger executables.
976
977 This option is currently only supported on ELF platforms.
978
979 @kindex --force-dynamic
980 @cindex forcing the creation of dynamic sections
981 @item --force-dynamic
982 Force the output file to have dynamic sections. This option is specific
983 to VxWorks targets.
984
985 @cindex partial link
986 @cindex relocatable output
987 @kindex -r
988 @kindex --relocatable
989 @item -r
990 @itemx --relocatable
991 Generate relocatable output---i.e., generate an output file that can in
992 turn serve as input to @command{ld}. This is often called @dfn{partial
993 linking}. As a side effect, in environments that support standard Unix
994 magic numbers, this option also sets the output file's magic number to
995 @code{OMAGIC}.
996 @c ; see @option{-N}.
997 If this option is not specified, an absolute file is produced. When
998 linking C++ programs, this option @emph{will not} resolve references to
999 constructors; to do that, use @samp{-Ur}.
1000
1001 When an input file does not have the same format as the output file,
1002 partial linking is only supported if that input file does not contain any
1003 relocations. Different output formats can have further restrictions; for
1004 example some @code{a.out}-based formats do not support partial linking
1005 with input files in other formats at all.
1006
1007 This option does the same thing as @samp{-i}.
1008
1009 @kindex -R @var{file}
1010 @kindex --just-symbols=@var{file}
1011 @cindex symbol-only input
1012 @item -R @var{filename}
1013 @itemx --just-symbols=@var{filename}
1014 Read symbol names and their addresses from @var{filename}, but do not
1015 relocate it or include it in the output. This allows your output file
1016 to refer symbolically to absolute locations of memory defined in other
1017 programs. You may use this option more than once.
1018
1019 For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
1020 followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
1021 the @option{-rpath} option.
1022
1023 @kindex -s
1024 @kindex --strip-all
1025 @cindex strip all symbols
1026 @item -s
1027 @itemx --strip-all
1028 Omit all symbol information from the output file.
1029
1030 @kindex -S
1031 @kindex --strip-debug
1032 @cindex strip debugger symbols
1033 @item -S
1034 @itemx --strip-debug
1035 Omit debugger symbol information (but not all symbols) from the output file.
1036
1037 @kindex --strip-discarded
1038 @kindex --no-strip-discarded
1039 @item --strip-discarded
1040 @itemx --no-strip-discarded
1041 Omit (or do not omit) global symbols defined in discarded sections.
1042 Enabled by default.
1043
1044 @kindex -t
1045 @kindex --trace
1046 @cindex input files, displaying
1047 @item -t
1048 @itemx --trace
1049 Print the names of the input files as @command{ld} processes them. If
1050 @samp{-t} is given twice then members within archives are also printed.
1051 @samp{-t} output is useful to generate a list of all the object files
1052 and scripts involved in linking, for example, when packaging files for
1053 a linker bug report.
1054
1055 @kindex -T @var{script}
1056 @kindex --script=@var{script}
1057 @cindex script files
1058 @item -T @var{scriptfile}
1059 @itemx --script=@var{scriptfile}
1060 Use @var{scriptfile} as the linker script. This script replaces
1061 @command{ld}'s default linker script (rather than adding to it), so
1062 @var{commandfile} must specify everything necessary to describe the
1063 output file. @xref{Scripts}. If @var{scriptfile} does not exist in
1064 the current directory, @code{ld} looks for it in the directories
1065 specified by any preceding @samp{-L} options. Multiple @samp{-T}
1066 options accumulate.
1067
1068 @kindex -dT @var{script}
1069 @kindex --default-script=@var{script}
1070 @cindex script files
1071 @item -dT @var{scriptfile}
1072 @itemx --default-script=@var{scriptfile}
1073 Use @var{scriptfile} as the default linker script. @xref{Scripts}.
1074
1075 This option is similar to the @option{--script} option except that
1076 processing of the script is delayed until after the rest of the
1077 command line has been processed. This allows options placed after the
1078 @option{--default-script} option on the command line to affect the
1079 behaviour of the linker script, which can be important when the linker
1080 command line cannot be directly controlled by the user. (eg because
1081 the command line is being constructed by another tool, such as
1082 @samp{gcc}).
1083
1084 @kindex -u @var{symbol}
1085 @kindex --undefined=@var{symbol}
1086 @cindex undefined symbol
1087 @item -u @var{symbol}
1088 @itemx --undefined=@var{symbol}
1089 Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
1090 symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
1091 modules from standard libraries. @samp{-u} may be repeated with
1092 different option arguments to enter additional undefined symbols. This
1093 option is equivalent to the @code{EXTERN} linker script command.
1094
1095 If this option is being used to force additional modules to be pulled
1096 into the link, and if it is an error for the symbol to remain
1097 undefined, then the option @option{--require-defined} should be used
1098 instead.
1099
1100 @kindex --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1101 @cindex symbols, require defined
1102 @cindex defined symbol
1103 @item --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1104 Require that @var{symbol} is defined in the output file. This option
1105 is the same as option @option{--undefined} except that if @var{symbol}
1106 is not defined in the output file then the linker will issue an error
1107 and exit. The same effect can be achieved in a linker script by using
1108 @code{EXTERN}, @code{ASSERT} and @code{DEFINED} together. This option
1109 can be used multiple times to require additional symbols.
1110
1111 @kindex -Ur
1112 @cindex constructors
1113 @item -Ur
1114 For anything other than C++ programs, this option is equivalent to
1115 @samp{-r}: it generates relocatable output---i.e., an output file that can in
1116 turn serve as input to @command{ld}. When linking C++ programs, @samp{-Ur}
1117 @emph{does} resolve references to constructors, unlike @samp{-r}.
1118 It does not work to use @samp{-Ur} on files that were themselves linked
1119 with @samp{-Ur}; once the constructor table has been built, it cannot
1120 be added to. Use @samp{-Ur} only for the last partial link, and
1121 @samp{-r} for the others.
1122
1123 @kindex --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1124 @cindex orphan sections
1125 @cindex sections, orphan
1126 @item --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1127 Control how orphan sections are handled. An orphan section is one not
1128 specifically mentioned in a linker script. @xref{Orphan Sections}.
1129
1130 @var{MODE} can have any of the following values:
1131
1132 @table @code
1133 @item place
1134 Orphan sections are placed into a suitable output section following
1135 the strategy described in @ref{Orphan Sections}. The option
1136 @samp{--unique} also affects how sections are placed.
1137
1138 @item discard
1139 All orphan sections are discarded, by placing them in the
1140 @samp{/DISCARD/} section (@pxref{Output Section Discarding}).
1141
1142 @item warn
1143 The linker will place the orphan section as for @code{place} and also
1144 issue a warning.
1145
1146 @item error
1147 The linker will exit with an error if any orphan section is found.
1148 @end table
1149
1150 The default if @samp{--orphan-handling} is not given is @code{place}.
1151
1152 @kindex --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1153 @item --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1154 Creates a separate output section for every input section matching
1155 @var{SECTION}, or if the optional wildcard @var{SECTION} argument is
1156 missing, for every orphan input section. An orphan section is one not
1157 specifically mentioned in a linker script. You may use this option
1158 multiple times on the command line; It prevents the normal merging of
1159 input sections with the same name, overriding output section assignments
1160 in a linker script.
1161
1162 @kindex -v
1163 @kindex -V
1164 @kindex --version
1165 @cindex version
1166 @item -v
1167 @itemx --version
1168 @itemx -V
1169 Display the version number for @command{ld}. The @option{-V} option also
1170 lists the supported emulations.
1171
1172 @kindex -x
1173 @kindex --discard-all
1174 @cindex deleting local symbols
1175 @item -x
1176 @itemx --discard-all
1177 Delete all local symbols.
1178
1179 @kindex -X
1180 @kindex --discard-locals
1181 @cindex local symbols, deleting
1182 @item -X
1183 @itemx --discard-locals
1184 Delete all temporary local symbols. (These symbols start with
1185 system-specific local label prefixes, typically @samp{.L} for ELF systems
1186 or @samp{L} for traditional a.out systems.)
1187
1188 @kindex -y @var{symbol}
1189 @kindex --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1190 @cindex symbol tracing
1191 @item -y @var{symbol}
1192 @itemx --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1193 Print the name of each linked file in which @var{symbol} appears. This
1194 option may be given any number of times. On many systems it is necessary
1195 to prepend an underscore.
1196
1197 This option is useful when you have an undefined symbol in your link but
1198 don't know where the reference is coming from.
1199
1200 @kindex -Y @var{path}
1201 @item -Y @var{path}
1202 Add @var{path} to the default library search path. This option exists
1203 for Solaris compatibility.
1204
1205 @kindex -z @var{keyword}
1206 @item -z @var{keyword}
1207 The recognized keywords are:
1208 @table @samp
1209
1210 @item bndplt
1211 Always generate BND prefix in PLT entries. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1212
1213 @item call-nop=prefix-addr
1214 @itemx call-nop=suffix-nop
1215 @itemx call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}
1216 @itemx call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}
1217 Specify the 1-byte @code{NOP} padding when transforming indirect call
1218 to a locally defined function, foo, via its GOT slot.
1219 @option{call-nop=prefix-addr} generates @code{0x67 call foo}.
1220 @option{call-nop=suffix-nop} generates @code{call foo 0x90}.
1221 @option{call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}} generates @code{@var{byte} call foo}.
1222 @option{call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}} generates @code{call foo @var{byte}}.
1223 Supported for i386 and x86_64.
1224
1225 @item cet-report=none
1226 @itemx cet-report=warning
1227 @itemx cet-report=error
1228 Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT and
1229 GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK properties in input .note.gnu.property
1230 section. @option{cet-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1231 linker not report missing properties in input files.
1232 @option{cet-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1233 missing properties in input files. @option{cet-report=error} will make
1234 the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1235 Note that @option{ibt} will turn off the missing
1236 GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT property report and @option{shstk} will
1237 turn off the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK property report.
1238 Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1239
1240 @item combreloc
1241 @itemx nocombreloc
1242 Combine multiple dynamic relocation sections and sort to improve
1243 dynamic symbol lookup caching. Do not do this if @samp{nocombreloc}.
1244
1245 @item common
1246 @itemx nocommon
1247 Generate common symbols with STT_COMMON type during a relocatable
1248 link. Use STT_OBJECT type if @samp{nocommon}.
1249
1250 @item common-page-size=@var{value}
1251 Set the page size most commonly used to @var{value}. Memory image
1252 layout will be optimized to minimize memory pages if the system is
1253 using pages of this size.
1254
1255 @item defs
1256 Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
1257 is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
1258 This option is the inverse of @samp{-z undefs}.
1259
1260 @item dynamic-undefined-weak
1261 @itemx nodynamic-undefined-weak
1262 Make undefined weak symbols dynamic when building a dynamic object,
1263 if they are referenced from a regular object file and not forced local
1264 by symbol visibility or versioning. Do not make them dynamic if
1265 @samp{nodynamic-undefined-weak}. If neither option is given, a target
1266 may default to either option being in force, or make some other
1267 selection of undefined weak symbols dynamic. Not all targets support
1268 these options.
1269
1270 @item execstack
1271 Marks the object as requiring executable stack.
1272
1273 @item global
1274 This option is only meaningful when building a shared object. It makes
1275 the symbols defined by this shared object available for symbol resolution
1276 of subsequently loaded libraries.
1277
1278 @item globalaudit
1279 This option is only meaningful when building a dynamic executable.
1280 This option marks the executable as requiring global auditing by
1281 setting the @code{DF_1_GLOBAUDIT} bit in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} dynamic
1282 tag. Global auditing requires that any auditing library defined via
1283 the @option{--depaudit} or @option{-P} command-line options be run for
1284 all dynamic objects loaded by the application.
1285
1286 @item ibtplt
1287 Generate Intel Indirect Branch Tracking (IBT) enabled PLT entries.
1288 Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1289
1290 @item ibt
1291 Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT in .note.gnu.property section
1292 to indicate compatibility with IBT. This also implies @option{ibtplt}.
1293 Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1294
1295 @item initfirst
1296 This option is only meaningful when building a shared object.
1297 It marks the object so that its runtime initialization will occur
1298 before the runtime initialization of any other objects brought into
1299 the process at the same time. Similarly the runtime finalization of
1300 the object will occur after the runtime finalization of any other
1301 objects.
1302
1303 @item interpose
1304 Specify that the dynamic loader should modify its symbol search order
1305 so that symbols in this shared library interpose all other shared
1306 libraries not so marked.
1307
1308 @item lazy
1309 When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1310 dynamic linker to defer function call resolution to the point when
1311 the function is called (lazy binding), rather than at load time.
1312 Lazy binding is the default.
1313
1314 @item loadfltr
1315 Specify that the object's filters be processed immediately at runtime.
1316
1317 @item max-page-size=@var{value}
1318 Set the maximum memory page size supported to @var{value}.
1319
1320 @item muldefs
1321 Allow multiple definitions.
1322
1323 @item nocopyreloc
1324 Disable linker generated .dynbss variables used in place of variables
1325 defined in shared libraries. May result in dynamic text relocations.
1326
1327 @item nodefaultlib
1328 Specify that the dynamic loader search for dependencies of this object
1329 should ignore any default library search paths.
1330
1331 @item nodelete
1332 Specify that the object shouldn't be unloaded at runtime.
1333
1334 @item nodlopen
1335 Specify that the object is not available to @code{dlopen}.
1336
1337 @item nodump
1338 Specify that the object can not be dumped by @code{dldump}.
1339
1340 @item noexecstack
1341 Marks the object as not requiring executable stack.
1342
1343 @item noextern-protected-data
1344 Don't treat protected data symbols as external when building a shared
1345 library. This option overrides the linker backend default. It can be
1346 used to work around incorrect relocations against protected data symbols
1347 generated by compiler. Updates on protected data symbols by another
1348 module aren't visible to the resulting shared library. Supported for
1349 i386 and x86-64.
1350
1351 @item noreloc-overflow
1352 Disable relocation overflow check. This can be used to disable
1353 relocation overflow check if there will be no dynamic relocation
1354 overflow at run-time. Supported for x86_64.
1355
1356 @item now
1357 When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1358 dynamic linker to resolve all symbols when the program is started, or
1359 when the shared library is loaded by dlopen, instead of deferring
1360 function call resolution to the point when the function is first
1361 called.
1362
1363 @item origin
1364 Specify that the object requires @samp{$ORIGIN} handling in paths.
1365
1366 @item relro
1367 @itemx norelro
1368 Create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment header in the object. This
1369 specifies a memory segment that should be made read-only after
1370 relocation, if supported. Specifying @samp{common-page-size} smaller
1371 than the system page size will render this protection ineffective.
1372 Don't create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment if @samp{norelro}.
1373
1374 @item separate-code
1375 @itemx noseparate-code
1376 Create separate code @code{PT_LOAD} segment header in the object. This
1377 specifies a memory segment that should contain only instructions and must
1378 be in wholly disjoint pages from any other data. Don't create separate
1379 code @code{PT_LOAD} segment if @samp{noseparate-code} is used.
1380
1381 @item unique-symbol
1382 @itemx nounique-symbol
1383 Avoid duplicated local symbol names in the symbol string table. Append
1384 ".@code{number}" to duplicated local symbol names if @samp{unique-symbol}
1385 is used. @option{nounique-symbol} is the default.
1386
1387 @item shstk
1388 Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK in .note.gnu.property section
1389 to indicate compatibility with Intel Shadow Stack. Supported for
1390 Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1391
1392 @item stack-size=@var{value}
1393 Specify a stack size for an ELF @code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment.
1394 Specifying zero will override any default non-zero sized
1395 @code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment creation.
1396
1397 @item start-stop-visibility=@var{value}
1398 @cindex visibility
1399 @cindex ELF symbol visibility
1400 Specify the ELF symbol visibility for synthesized
1401 @code{__start_SECNAME} and @code{__stop_SECNAME} symbols (@pxref{Input
1402 Section Example}). @var{value} must be exactly @samp{default},
1403 @samp{internal}, @samp{hidden}, or @samp{protected}. If no @samp{-z
1404 start-stop-visibility} option is given, @samp{protected} is used for
1405 compatibility with historical practice. However, it's highly
1406 recommended to use @samp{-z start-stop-visibility=hidden} in new
1407 programs and shared libraries so that these symbols are not exported
1408 between shared objects, which is not usually what's intended.
1409
1410 @item text
1411 @itemx notext
1412 @itemx textoff
1413 Report an error if DT_TEXTREL is set, i.e., if the position-independent
1414 or shared object has dynamic relocations in read-only sections. Don't
1415 report an error if @samp{notext} or @samp{textoff}.
1416
1417 @item undefs
1418 Do not report unresolved symbol references from regular object files,
1419 either when creating an executable, or when creating a shared library.
1420 This option is the inverse of @samp{-z defs}.
1421
1422 @end table
1423
1424 Other keywords are ignored for Solaris compatibility.
1425
1426 @kindex -(
1427 @cindex groups of archives
1428 @item -( @var{archives} -)
1429 @itemx --start-group @var{archives} --end-group
1430 The @var{archives} should be a list of archive files. They may be
1431 either explicit file names, or @samp{-l} options.
1432
1433 The specified archives are searched repeatedly until no new undefined
1434 references are created. Normally, an archive is searched only once in
1435 the order that it is specified on the command line. If a symbol in that
1436 archive is needed to resolve an undefined symbol referred to by an
1437 object in an archive that appears later on the command line, the linker
1438 would not be able to resolve that reference. By grouping the archives,
1439 they will all be searched repeatedly until all possible references are
1440 resolved.
1441
1442 Using this option has a significant performance cost. It is best to use
1443 it only when there are unavoidable circular references between two or
1444 more archives.
1445
1446 @kindex --accept-unknown-input-arch
1447 @kindex --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1448 @item --accept-unknown-input-arch
1449 @itemx --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1450 Tells the linker to accept input files whose architecture cannot be
1451 recognised. The assumption is that the user knows what they are doing
1452 and deliberately wants to link in these unknown input files. This was
1453 the default behaviour of the linker, before release 2.14. The default
1454 behaviour from release 2.14 onwards is to reject such input files, and
1455 so the @samp{--accept-unknown-input-arch} option has been added to
1456 restore the old behaviour.
1457
1458 @kindex --as-needed
1459 @kindex --no-as-needed
1460 @item --as-needed
1461 @itemx --no-as-needed
1462 This option affects ELF DT_NEEDED tags for dynamic libraries mentioned
1463 on the command line after the @option{--as-needed} option. Normally
1464 the linker will add a DT_NEEDED tag for each dynamic library mentioned
1465 on the command line, regardless of whether the library is actually
1466 needed or not. @option{--as-needed} causes a DT_NEEDED tag to only be
1467 emitted for a library that @emph{at that point in the link} satisfies a
1468 non-weak undefined symbol reference from a regular object file or, if
1469 the library is not found in the DT_NEEDED lists of other needed libraries, a
1470 non-weak undefined symbol reference from another needed dynamic library.
1471 Object files or libraries appearing on the command line @emph{after}
1472 the library in question do not affect whether the library is seen as
1473 needed. This is similar to the rules for extraction of object files
1474 from archives. @option{--no-as-needed} restores the default behaviour.
1475
1476 @kindex --add-needed
1477 @kindex --no-add-needed
1478 @item --add-needed
1479 @itemx --no-add-needed
1480 These two options have been deprecated because of the similarity of
1481 their names to the @option{--as-needed} and @option{--no-as-needed}
1482 options. They have been replaced by @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
1483 and @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
1484
1485 @kindex -assert @var{keyword}
1486 @item -assert @var{keyword}
1487 This option is ignored for SunOS compatibility.
1488
1489 @kindex -Bdynamic
1490 @kindex -dy
1491 @kindex -call_shared
1492 @item -Bdynamic
1493 @itemx -dy
1494 @itemx -call_shared
1495 Link against dynamic libraries. This is only meaningful on platforms
1496 for which shared libraries are supported. This option is normally the
1497 default on such platforms. The different variants of this option are
1498 for compatibility with various systems. You may use this option
1499 multiple times on the command line: it affects library searching for
1500 @option{-l} options which follow it.
1501
1502 @kindex -Bgroup
1503 @item -Bgroup
1504 Set the @code{DF_1_GROUP} flag in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} entry in the dynamic
1505 section. This causes the runtime linker to handle lookups in this
1506 object and its dependencies to be performed only inside the group.
1507 @option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all} is implied. This option is
1508 only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
1509
1510 @kindex -Bstatic
1511 @kindex -dn
1512 @kindex -non_shared
1513 @kindex -static
1514 @item -Bstatic
1515 @itemx -dn
1516 @itemx -non_shared
1517 @itemx -static
1518 Do not link against shared libraries. This is only meaningful on
1519 platforms for which shared libraries are supported. The different
1520 variants of this option are for compatibility with various systems. You
1521 may use this option multiple times on the command line: it affects
1522 library searching for @option{-l} options which follow it. This
1523 option also implies @option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all}. This
1524 option can be used with @option{-shared}. Doing so means that a
1525 shared library is being created but that all of the library's external
1526 references must be resolved by pulling in entries from static
1527 libraries.
1528
1529 @kindex -Bsymbolic
1530 @item -Bsymbolic
1531 When creating a shared library, bind references to global symbols to the
1532 definition within the shared library, if any. Normally, it is possible
1533 for a program linked against a shared library to override the definition
1534 within the shared library. This option is only meaningful on ELF
1535 platforms which support shared libraries.
1536
1537 @kindex -Bsymbolic-functions
1538 @item -Bsymbolic-functions
1539 When creating a shared library, bind references to global function
1540 symbols to the definition within the shared library, if any.
1541 This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared
1542 libraries.
1543
1544 @kindex --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1545 @item --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1546 Specify the name of a dynamic list file to the linker. This is
1547 typically used when creating shared libraries to specify a list of
1548 global symbols whose references shouldn't be bound to the definition
1549 within the shared library, or creating dynamically linked executables
1550 to specify a list of symbols which should be added to the symbol table
1551 in the executable. This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms
1552 which support shared libraries.
1553
1554 The format of the dynamic list is the same as the version node without
1555 scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
1556
1557 @kindex --dynamic-list-data
1558 @item --dynamic-list-data
1559 Include all global data symbols to the dynamic list.
1560
1561 @kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1562 @item --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1563 Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ operator new and delete. It
1564 is mainly useful for building shared libstdc++.
1565
1566 @kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1567 @item --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1568 Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ runtime type identification.
1569
1570 @kindex --check-sections
1571 @kindex --no-check-sections
1572 @item --check-sections
1573 @itemx --no-check-sections
1574 Asks the linker @emph{not} to check section addresses after they have
1575 been assigned to see if there are any overlaps. Normally the linker will
1576 perform this check, and if it finds any overlaps it will produce
1577 suitable error messages. The linker does know about, and does make
1578 allowances for sections in overlays. The default behaviour can be
1579 restored by using the command-line switch @option{--check-sections}.
1580 Section overlap is not usually checked for relocatable links. You can
1581 force checking in that case by using the @option{--check-sections}
1582 option.
1583
1584 @kindex --copy-dt-needed-entries
1585 @kindex --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
1586 @item --copy-dt-needed-entries
1587 @itemx --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
1588 This option affects the treatment of dynamic libraries referred to
1589 by DT_NEEDED tags @emph{inside} ELF dynamic libraries mentioned on the
1590 command line. Normally the linker won't add a DT_NEEDED tag to the
1591 output binary for each library mentioned in a DT_NEEDED tag in an
1592 input dynamic library. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
1593 specified on the command line however any dynamic libraries that
1594 follow it will have their DT_NEEDED entries added. The default
1595 behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
1596
1597 This option also has an effect on the resolution of symbols in dynamic
1598 libraries. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries} dynamic libraries
1599 mentioned on the command line will be recursively searched, following
1600 their DT_NEEDED tags to other libraries, in order to resolve symbols
1601 required by the output binary. With the default setting however
1602 the searching of dynamic libraries that follow it will stop with the
1603 dynamic library itself. No DT_NEEDED links will be traversed to resolve
1604 symbols.
1605
1606 @cindex cross reference table
1607 @kindex --cref
1608 @item --cref
1609 Output a cross reference table. If a linker map file is being
1610 generated, the cross reference table is printed to the map file.
1611 Otherwise, it is printed on the standard output.
1612
1613 The format of the table is intentionally simple, so that it may be
1614 easily processed by a script if necessary. The symbols are printed out,
1615 sorted by name. For each symbol, a list of file names is given. If the
1616 symbol is defined, the first file listed is the location of the
1617 definition. If the symbol is defined as a common value then any files
1618 where this happens appear next. Finally any files that reference the
1619 symbol are listed.
1620
1621 @cindex ctf variables
1622 @kindex --ctf-variables
1623 @kindex --no-ctf-variables
1624 @item --ctf-variables
1625 @item --no-ctf-variables
1626 The CTF debuginfo format supports a section which encodes the names and
1627 types of variables found in the program which do not appear in any symbol
1628 table. These variables clearly cannot be looked up by address by
1629 conventional debuggers, so the space used for their types and names is
1630 usually wasted: the types are usually small but the names are often not.
1631 @option{--ctf-variables} causes the generation of such a section.
1632 The default behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-ctf-variables}.
1633
1634 @cindex ctf type sharing
1635 @kindex --ctf-share-types
1636 @item --ctf-share-types=@var{method}
1637 Adjust the method used to share types between translation units in CTF.
1638
1639 @table @samp
1640 @item share-unconflicted
1641 Put all types that do not have ambiguous definitions into the shared dictionary,
1642 where debuggers can easily access them, even if they only occur in one
1643 translation unit. This is the default.
1644
1645 @item share-duplicated
1646 Put only types that occur in multiple translation units into the shared
1647 dictionary: types with only one definition go into per-translation-unit
1648 dictionaries. Types with ambiguous definitions in multiple translation units
1649 always go into per-translation-unit dictionaries. This tends to make the CTF
1650 larger, but may reduce the amount of CTF in the shared dictionary. For very
1651 large projects this may speed up opening the CTF and save memory in the CTF
1652 consumer at runtime.
1653 @end table
1654
1655 @cindex common allocation
1656 @kindex --no-define-common
1657 @item --no-define-common
1658 This option inhibits the assignment of addresses to common symbols.
1659 The script command @code{INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
1660 @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1661
1662 The @samp{--no-define-common} option allows decoupling
1663 the decision to assign addresses to Common symbols from the choice
1664 of the output file type; otherwise a non-Relocatable output type
1665 forces assigning addresses to Common symbols.
1666 Using @samp{--no-define-common} allows Common symbols that are referenced
1667 from a shared library to be assigned addresses only in the main program.
1668 This eliminates the unused duplicate space in the shared library,
1669 and also prevents any possible confusion over resolving to the wrong
1670 duplicate when there are many dynamic modules with specialized search
1671 paths for runtime symbol resolution.
1672
1673 @cindex group allocation in linker script
1674 @cindex section groups
1675 @cindex COMDAT
1676 @kindex --force-group-allocation
1677 @item --force-group-allocation
1678 This option causes the linker to place section group members like
1679 normal input sections, and to delete the section groups. This is the
1680 default behaviour for a final link but this option can be used to
1681 change the behaviour of a relocatable link (@samp{-r}). The script
1682 command @code{FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION} has the same
1683 effect. @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1684
1685 @cindex symbols, from command line
1686 @kindex --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{exp}
1687 @item --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{expression}
1688 Create a global symbol in the output file, containing the absolute
1689 address given by @var{expression}. You may use this option as many
1690 times as necessary to define multiple symbols in the command line. A
1691 limited form of arithmetic is supported for the @var{expression} in this
1692 context: you may give a hexadecimal constant or the name of an existing
1693 symbol, or use @code{+} and @code{-} to add or subtract hexadecimal
1694 constants or symbols. If you need more elaborate expressions, consider
1695 using the linker command language from a script (@pxref{Assignments}).
1696 @emph{Note:} there should be no white space between @var{symbol}, the
1697 equals sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{expression}.
1698
1699 @cindex demangling, from command line
1700 @kindex --demangle[=@var{style}]
1701 @kindex --no-demangle
1702 @item --demangle[=@var{style}]
1703 @itemx --no-demangle
1704 These options control whether to demangle symbol names in error messages
1705 and other output. When the linker is told to demangle, it tries to
1706 present symbol names in a readable fashion: it strips leading
1707 underscores if they are used by the object file format, and converts C++
1708 mangled symbol names into user readable names. Different compilers have
1709 different mangling styles. The optional demangling style argument can be used
1710 to choose an appropriate demangling style for your compiler. The linker will
1711 demangle by default unless the environment variable @samp{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}
1712 is set. These options may be used to override the default.
1713
1714 @cindex dynamic linker, from command line
1715 @kindex -I@var{file}
1716 @kindex --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
1717 @item -I@var{file}
1718 @itemx --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
1719 Set the name of the dynamic linker. This is only meaningful when
1720 generating dynamically linked ELF executables. The default dynamic
1721 linker is normally correct; don't use this unless you know what you are
1722 doing.
1723
1724 @kindex --no-dynamic-linker
1725 @item --no-dynamic-linker
1726 When producing an executable file, omit the request for a dynamic
1727 linker to be used at load-time. This is only meaningful for ELF
1728 executables that contain dynamic relocations, and usually requires
1729 entry point code that is capable of processing these relocations.
1730
1731 @kindex --embedded-relocs
1732 @item --embedded-relocs
1733 This option is similar to the @option{--emit-relocs} option except
1734 that the relocs are stored in a target-specific section. This option
1735 is only supported by the @samp{BFIN}, @samp{CR16} and @emph{M68K}
1736 targets.
1737
1738 @kindex --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1739 @item --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1740 Do not allow multiple definitions with symbols included
1741 in filename invoked by -R or --just-symbols
1742
1743 @kindex --fatal-warnings
1744 @kindex --no-fatal-warnings
1745 @item --fatal-warnings
1746 @itemx --no-fatal-warnings
1747 Treat all warnings as errors. The default behaviour can be restored
1748 with the option @option{--no-fatal-warnings}.
1749
1750 @kindex --force-exe-suffix
1751 @item --force-exe-suffix
1752 Make sure that an output file has a .exe suffix.
1753
1754 If a successfully built fully linked output file does not have a
1755 @code{.exe} or @code{.dll} suffix, this option forces the linker to copy
1756 the output file to one of the same name with a @code{.exe} suffix. This
1757 option is useful when using unmodified Unix makefiles on a Microsoft
1758 Windows host, since some versions of Windows won't run an image unless
1759 it ends in a @code{.exe} suffix.
1760
1761 @kindex --gc-sections
1762 @kindex --no-gc-sections
1763 @cindex garbage collection
1764 @item --gc-sections
1765 @itemx --no-gc-sections
1766 Enable garbage collection of unused input sections. It is ignored on
1767 targets that do not support this option. The default behaviour (of not
1768 performing this garbage collection) can be restored by specifying
1769 @samp{--no-gc-sections} on the command line. Note that garbage
1770 collection for COFF and PE format targets is supported, but the
1771 implementation is currently considered to be experimental.
1772
1773 @samp{--gc-sections} decides which input sections are used by
1774 examining symbols and relocations. The section containing the entry
1775 symbol and all sections containing symbols undefined on the
1776 command-line will be kept, as will sections containing symbols
1777 referenced by dynamic objects. Note that when building shared
1778 libraries, the linker must assume that any visible symbol is
1779 referenced. Once this initial set of sections has been determined,
1780 the linker recursively marks as used any section referenced by their
1781 relocations. See @samp{--entry}, @samp{--undefined}, and
1782 @samp{--gc-keep-exported}.
1783
1784 This option can be set when doing a partial link (enabled with option
1785 @samp{-r}). In this case the root of symbols kept must be explicitly
1786 specified either by one of the options @samp{--entry},
1787 @samp{--undefined}, or @samp{--gc-keep-exported} or by a @code{ENTRY}
1788 command in the linker script.
1789
1790 @kindex --print-gc-sections
1791 @kindex --no-print-gc-sections
1792 @cindex garbage collection
1793 @item --print-gc-sections
1794 @itemx --no-print-gc-sections
1795 List all sections removed by garbage collection. The listing is
1796 printed on stderr. This option is only effective if garbage
1797 collection has been enabled via the @samp{--gc-sections}) option. The
1798 default behaviour (of not listing the sections that are removed) can
1799 be restored by specifying @samp{--no-print-gc-sections} on the command
1800 line.
1801
1802 @kindex --gc-keep-exported
1803 @cindex garbage collection
1804 @item --gc-keep-exported
1805 When @samp{--gc-sections} is enabled, this option prevents garbage
1806 collection of unused input sections that contain global symbols having
1807 default or protected visibility. This option is intended to be used for
1808 executables where unreferenced sections would otherwise be garbage
1809 collected regardless of the external visibility of contained symbols.
1810 Note that this option has no effect when linking shared objects since
1811 it is already the default behaviour. This option is only supported for
1812 ELF format targets.
1813
1814 @kindex --print-output-format
1815 @cindex output format
1816 @item --print-output-format
1817 Print the name of the default output format (perhaps influenced by
1818 other command-line options). This is the string that would appear
1819 in an @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} linker script command (@pxref{File Commands}).
1820
1821 @kindex --print-memory-usage
1822 @cindex memory usage
1823 @item --print-memory-usage
1824 Print used size, total size and used size of memory regions created with
1825 the @ref{MEMORY} command. This is useful on embedded targets to have a
1826 quick view of amount of free memory. The format of the output has one
1827 headline and one line per region. It is both human readable and easily
1828 parsable by tools. Here is an example of an output:
1829
1830 @smallexample
1831 Memory region Used Size Region Size %age Used
1832 ROM: 256 KB 1 MB 25.00%
1833 RAM: 32 B 2 GB 0.00%
1834 @end smallexample
1835
1836 @cindex help
1837 @cindex usage
1838 @kindex --help
1839 @item --help
1840 Print a summary of the command-line options on the standard output and exit.
1841
1842 @kindex --target-help
1843 @item --target-help
1844 Print a summary of all target-specific options on the standard output and exit.
1845
1846 @kindex -Map=@var{mapfile}
1847 @item -Map=@var{mapfile}
1848 Print a link map to the file @var{mapfile}. See the description of the
1849 @option{-M} option, above. Specifying a directory as @var{mapfile}
1850 causes the linker map to be written into a file inside the directory.
1851 The name of the file is based upon the @var{output} filename with
1852 @code{.map} appended.
1853
1854 @cindex memory usage
1855 @kindex --no-keep-memory
1856 @item --no-keep-memory
1857 @command{ld} normally optimizes for speed over memory usage by caching the
1858 symbol tables of input files in memory. This option tells @command{ld} to
1859 instead optimize for memory usage, by rereading the symbol tables as
1860 necessary. This may be required if @command{ld} runs out of memory space
1861 while linking a large executable.
1862
1863 @kindex --no-undefined
1864 @kindex -z defs
1865 @kindex -z undefs
1866 @item --no-undefined
1867 @itemx -z defs
1868 Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
1869 is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
1870 The switch @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} controls the
1871 behaviour for reporting unresolved references found in shared
1872 libraries being linked in.
1873
1874 The effects of this option can be reverted by using @code{-z undefs}.
1875
1876 @kindex --allow-multiple-definition
1877 @kindex -z muldefs
1878 @item --allow-multiple-definition
1879 @itemx -z muldefs
1880 Normally when a symbol is defined multiple times, the linker will
1881 report a fatal error. These options allow multiple definitions and the
1882 first definition will be used.
1883
1884 @kindex --allow-shlib-undefined
1885 @kindex --no-allow-shlib-undefined
1886 @item --allow-shlib-undefined
1887 @itemx --no-allow-shlib-undefined
1888 Allows or disallows undefined symbols in shared libraries.
1889 This switch is similar to @option{--no-undefined} except that it
1890 determines the behaviour when the undefined symbols are in a
1891 shared library rather than a regular object file. It does not affect
1892 how undefined symbols in regular object files are handled.
1893
1894 The default behaviour is to report errors for any undefined symbols
1895 referenced in shared libraries if the linker is being used to create
1896 an executable, but to allow them if the linker is being used to create
1897 a shared library.
1898
1899 The reasons for allowing undefined symbol references in shared
1900 libraries specified at link time are that:
1901
1902 @itemize @bullet
1903 @item
1904 A shared library specified at link time may not be the same as the one
1905 that is available at load time, so the symbol might actually be
1906 resolvable at load time.
1907 @item
1908 There are some operating systems, eg BeOS and HPPA, where undefined
1909 symbols in shared libraries are normal.
1910
1911 The BeOS kernel for example patches shared libraries at load time to
1912 select whichever function is most appropriate for the current
1913 architecture. This is used, for example, to dynamically select an
1914 appropriate memset function.
1915 @end itemize
1916
1917 @kindex --no-undefined-version
1918 @item --no-undefined-version
1919 Normally when a symbol has an undefined version, the linker will ignore
1920 it. This option disallows symbols with undefined version and a fatal error
1921 will be issued instead.
1922
1923 @kindex --default-symver
1924 @item --default-symver
1925 Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
1926 exported symbols.
1927
1928 @kindex --default-imported-symver
1929 @item --default-imported-symver
1930 Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
1931 imported symbols.
1932
1933 @kindex --no-warn-mismatch
1934 @item --no-warn-mismatch
1935 Normally @command{ld} will give an error if you try to link together input
1936 files that are mismatched for some reason, perhaps because they have
1937 been compiled for different processors or for different endiannesses.
1938 This option tells @command{ld} that it should silently permit such possible
1939 errors. This option should only be used with care, in cases when you
1940 have taken some special action that ensures that the linker errors are
1941 inappropriate.
1942
1943 @kindex --no-warn-search-mismatch
1944 @item --no-warn-search-mismatch
1945 Normally @command{ld} will give a warning if it finds an incompatible
1946 library during a library search. This option silences the warning.
1947
1948 @kindex --no-whole-archive
1949 @item --no-whole-archive
1950 Turn off the effect of the @option{--whole-archive} option for subsequent
1951 archive files.
1952
1953 @cindex output file after errors
1954 @kindex --noinhibit-exec
1955 @item --noinhibit-exec
1956 Retain the executable output file whenever it is still usable.
1957 Normally, the linker will not produce an output file if it encounters
1958 errors during the link process; it exits without writing an output file
1959 when it issues any error whatsoever.
1960
1961 @kindex -nostdlib
1962 @item -nostdlib
1963 Only search library directories explicitly specified on the
1964 command line. Library directories specified in linker scripts
1965 (including linker scripts specified on the command line) are ignored.
1966
1967 @ifclear SingleFormat
1968 @kindex --oformat=@var{output-format}
1969 @item --oformat=@var{output-format}
1970 @command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
1971 file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
1972 @samp{--oformat} option to specify the binary format for the output
1973 object file. Even when @command{ld} is configured to support alternative
1974 object formats, you don't usually need to specify this, as @command{ld}
1975 should be configured to produce as a default output format the most
1976 usual format on each machine. @var{output-format} is a text string, the
1977 name of a particular format supported by the BFD libraries. (You can
1978 list the available binary formats with @samp{objdump -i}.) The script
1979 command @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} can also specify the output format, but
1980 this option overrides it. @xref{BFD}.
1981 @end ifclear
1982
1983 @kindex --out-implib
1984 @item --out-implib @var{file}
1985 Create an import library in @var{file} corresponding to the executable
1986 the linker is generating (eg. a DLL or ELF program). This import
1987 library (which should be called @code{*.dll.a} or @code{*.a} for DLLs)
1988 may be used to link clients against the generated executable; this
1989 behaviour makes it possible to skip a separate import library creation
1990 step (eg. @code{dlltool} for DLLs). This option is only available for
1991 the i386 PE and ELF targetted ports of the linker.
1992
1993 @kindex -pie
1994 @kindex --pic-executable
1995 @item -pie
1996 @itemx --pic-executable
1997 @cindex position independent executables
1998 Create a position independent executable. This is currently only supported on
1999 ELF platforms. Position independent executables are similar to shared
2000 libraries in that they are relocated by the dynamic linker to the virtual
2001 address the OS chooses for them (which can vary between invocations). Like
2002 normal dynamically linked executables they can be executed and symbols
2003 defined in the executable cannot be overridden by shared libraries.
2004
2005 @kindex -qmagic
2006 @item -qmagic
2007 This option is ignored for Linux compatibility.
2008
2009 @kindex -Qy
2010 @item -Qy
2011 This option is ignored for SVR4 compatibility.
2012
2013 @kindex --relax
2014 @cindex synthesizing linker
2015 @cindex relaxing addressing modes
2016 @cindex --no-relax
2017 @item --relax
2018 @itemx --no-relax
2019 An option with machine dependent effects.
2020 @ifset GENERIC
2021 This option is only supported on a few targets.
2022 @end ifset
2023 @ifset H8300
2024 @xref{H8/300,,@command{ld} and the H8/300}.
2025 @end ifset
2026 @ifset XTENSA
2027 @xref{Xtensa,, @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors}.
2028 @end ifset
2029 @ifset M68HC11
2030 @xref{M68HC11/68HC12,,@command{ld} and the 68HC11 and 68HC12}.
2031 @end ifset
2032 @ifset NIOSII
2033 @xref{Nios II,,@command{ld} and the Altera Nios II}.
2034 @end ifset
2035 @ifset POWERPC
2036 @xref{PowerPC ELF32,,@command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support}.
2037 @end ifset
2038
2039 On some platforms the @option{--relax} option performs target specific,
2040 global optimizations that become possible when the linker resolves
2041 addressing in the program, such as relaxing address modes,
2042 synthesizing new instructions, selecting shorter version of current
2043 instructions, and combining constant values.
2044
2045 On some platforms these link time global optimizations may make symbolic
2046 debugging of the resulting executable impossible.
2047 @ifset GENERIC
2048 This is known to be the case for the Matsushita MN10200 and MN10300
2049 family of processors.
2050 @end ifset
2051
2052 On platforms where the feature is supported, the option
2053 @option{--no-relax} will disable it.
2054
2055 On platforms where the feature is not supported, both @option{--relax}
2056 and @option{--no-relax} are accepted, but ignored.
2057
2058 @cindex retaining specified symbols
2059 @cindex stripping all but some symbols
2060 @cindex symbols, retaining selectively
2061 @kindex --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
2062 @item --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
2063 Retain @emph{only} the symbols listed in the file @var{filename},
2064 discarding all others. @var{filename} is simply a flat file, with one
2065 symbol name per line. This option is especially useful in environments
2066 @ifset GENERIC
2067 (such as VxWorks)
2068 @end ifset
2069 where a large global symbol table is accumulated gradually, to conserve
2070 run-time memory.
2071
2072 @samp{--retain-symbols-file} does @emph{not} discard undefined symbols,
2073 or symbols needed for relocations.
2074
2075 You may only specify @samp{--retain-symbols-file} once in the command
2076 line. It overrides @samp{-s} and @samp{-S}.
2077
2078 @ifset GENERIC
2079 @item -rpath=@var{dir}
2080 @cindex runtime library search path
2081 @kindex -rpath=@var{dir}
2082 Add a directory to the runtime library search path. This is used when
2083 linking an ELF executable with shared objects. All @option{-rpath}
2084 arguments are concatenated and passed to the runtime linker, which uses
2085 them to locate shared objects at runtime.
2086
2087 The @option{-rpath} option is also used when locating shared objects which
2088 are needed by shared objects explicitly included in the link; see the
2089 description of the @option{-rpath-link} option. Searching @option{-rpath}
2090 in this way is only supported by native linkers and cross linkers which
2091 have been configured with the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
2092
2093 If @option{-rpath} is not used when linking an ELF executable, the
2094 contents of the environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH} will be used if it
2095 is defined.
2096
2097 The @option{-rpath} option may also be used on SunOS. By default, on
2098 SunOS, the linker will form a runtime search path out of all the
2099 @option{-L} options it is given. If a @option{-rpath} option is used, the
2100 runtime search path will be formed exclusively using the @option{-rpath}
2101 options, ignoring the @option{-L} options. This can be useful when using
2102 gcc, which adds many @option{-L} options which may be on NFS mounted
2103 file systems.
2104
2105 For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
2106 followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
2107 the @option{-rpath} option.
2108 @end ifset
2109
2110 @ifset GENERIC
2111 @cindex link-time runtime library search path
2112 @kindex -rpath-link=@var{dir}
2113 @item -rpath-link=@var{dir}
2114 When using ELF or SunOS, one shared library may require another. This
2115 happens when an @code{ld -shared} link includes a shared library as one
2116 of the input files.
2117
2118 When the linker encounters such a dependency when doing a non-shared,
2119 non-relocatable link, it will automatically try to locate the required
2120 shared library and include it in the link, if it is not included
2121 explicitly. In such a case, the @option{-rpath-link} option
2122 specifies the first set of directories to search. The
2123 @option{-rpath-link} option may specify a sequence of directory names
2124 either by specifying a list of names separated by colons, or by
2125 appearing multiple times.
2126
2127 The tokens @var{$ORIGIN} and @var{$LIB} can appear in these search
2128 directories. They will be replaced by the full path to the directory
2129 containing the program or shared object in the case of @var{$ORIGIN}
2130 and either @samp{lib} - for 32-bit binaries - or @samp{lib64} - for
2131 64-bit binaries - in the case of @var{$LIB}.
2132
2133 The alternative form of these tokens - @var{$@{ORIGIN@}} and
2134 @var{$@{LIB@}} can also be used. The token @var{$PLATFORM} is not
2135 supported.
2136
2137 This option should be used with caution as it overrides the search path
2138 that may have been hard compiled into a shared library. In such a case it
2139 is possible to use unintentionally a different search path than the
2140 runtime linker would do.
2141
2142 The linker uses the following search paths to locate required shared
2143 libraries:
2144
2145 @enumerate
2146 @item
2147 Any directories specified by @option{-rpath-link} options.
2148 @item
2149 Any directories specified by @option{-rpath} options. The difference
2150 between @option{-rpath} and @option{-rpath-link} is that directories
2151 specified by @option{-rpath} options are included in the executable and
2152 used at runtime, whereas the @option{-rpath-link} option is only effective
2153 at link time. Searching @option{-rpath} in this way is only supported
2154 by native linkers and cross linkers which have been configured with
2155 the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
2156 @item
2157 On an ELF system, for native linkers, if the @option{-rpath} and
2158 @option{-rpath-link} options were not used, search the contents of the
2159 environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH}.
2160 @item
2161 On SunOS, if the @option{-rpath} option was not used, search any
2162 directories specified using @option{-L} options.
2163 @item
2164 For a native linker, search the contents of the environment
2165 variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}.
2166 @item
2167 For a native ELF linker, the directories in @code{DT_RUNPATH} or
2168 @code{DT_RPATH} of a shared library are searched for shared
2169 libraries needed by it. The @code{DT_RPATH} entries are ignored if
2170 @code{DT_RUNPATH} entries exist.
2171 @item
2172 The default directories, normally @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib}.
2173 @item
2174 For a linker for a Linux system, if the file @file{/etc/ld.so.conf}
2175 exists, the list of directories found in that file. Note: the path
2176 to this file is prefixed with the @code{sysroot} value, if that is
2177 defined, and then any @code{prefix} string if the linker was
2178 configured with the @command{--prefix=<path>} option.
2179 @item
2180 For a native linker on a FreeBSD system, any directories specified by
2181 the @code{_PATH_ELF_HINTS} macro defined in the @file{elf-hints.h}
2182 header file.
2183 @item
2184 Any directories specifed by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in the
2185 linker script being used.
2186 @end enumerate
2187
2188 If the required shared library is not found, the linker will issue a
2189 warning and continue with the link.
2190 @end ifset
2191
2192 @kindex -shared
2193 @kindex -Bshareable
2194 @item -shared
2195 @itemx -Bshareable
2196 @cindex shared libraries
2197 Create a shared library. This is currently only supported on ELF, XCOFF
2198 and SunOS platforms. On SunOS, the linker will automatically create a
2199 shared library if the @option{-e} option is not used and there are
2200 undefined symbols in the link.
2201
2202 @kindex --sort-common
2203 @item --sort-common
2204 @itemx --sort-common=ascending
2205 @itemx --sort-common=descending
2206 This option tells @command{ld} to sort the common symbols by alignment in
2207 ascending or descending order when it places them in the appropriate output
2208 sections. The symbol alignments considered are sixteen-byte or larger,
2209 eight-byte, four-byte, two-byte, and one-byte. This is to prevent gaps
2210 between symbols due to alignment constraints. If no sorting order is
2211 specified, then descending order is assumed.
2212
2213 @kindex --sort-section=name
2214 @item --sort-section=name
2215 This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_NAME} to all wildcard section
2216 patterns in the linker script.
2217
2218 @kindex --sort-section=alignment
2219 @item --sort-section=alignment
2220 This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} to all wildcard section
2221 patterns in the linker script.
2222
2223 @kindex --spare-dynamic-tags
2224 @item --spare-dynamic-tags=@var{count}
2225 This option specifies the number of empty slots to leave in the
2226 .dynamic section of ELF shared objects. Empty slots may be needed by
2227 post processing tools, such as the prelinker. The default is 5.
2228
2229 @kindex --split-by-file
2230 @item --split-by-file[=@var{size}]
2231 Similar to @option{--split-by-reloc} but creates a new output section for
2232 each input file when @var{size} is reached. @var{size} defaults to a
2233 size of 1 if not given.
2234
2235 @kindex --split-by-reloc
2236 @item --split-by-reloc[=@var{count}]
2237 Tries to creates extra sections in the output file so that no single
2238 output section in the file contains more than @var{count} relocations.
2239 This is useful when generating huge relocatable files for downloading into
2240 certain real time kernels with the COFF object file format; since COFF
2241 cannot represent more than 65535 relocations in a single section. Note
2242 that this will fail to work with object file formats which do not
2243 support arbitrary sections. The linker will not split up individual
2244 input sections for redistribution, so if a single input section contains
2245 more than @var{count} relocations one output section will contain that
2246 many relocations. @var{count} defaults to a value of 32768.
2247
2248 @kindex --stats
2249 @item --stats
2250 Compute and display statistics about the operation of the linker, such
2251 as execution time and memory usage.
2252
2253 @kindex --sysroot=@var{directory}
2254 @item --sysroot=@var{directory}
2255 Use @var{directory} as the location of the sysroot, overriding the
2256 configure-time default. This option is only supported by linkers
2257 that were configured using @option{--with-sysroot}.
2258
2259 @kindex --task-link
2260 @item --task-link
2261 This is used by COFF/PE based targets to create a task-linked object
2262 file where all of the global symbols have been converted to statics.
2263
2264 @kindex --traditional-format
2265 @cindex traditional format
2266 @item --traditional-format
2267 For some targets, the output of @command{ld} is different in some ways from
2268 the output of some existing linker. This switch requests @command{ld} to
2269 use the traditional format instead.
2270
2271 @cindex dbx
2272 For example, on SunOS, @command{ld} combines duplicate entries in the
2273 symbol string table. This can reduce the size of an output file with
2274 full debugging information by over 30 percent. Unfortunately, the SunOS
2275 @code{dbx} program can not read the resulting program (@code{gdb} has no
2276 trouble). The @samp{--traditional-format} switch tells @command{ld} to not
2277 combine duplicate entries.
2278
2279 @kindex --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
2280 @item --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
2281 Locate a section in the output file at the absolute
2282 address given by @var{org}. You may use this option as many
2283 times as necessary to locate multiple sections in the command
2284 line.
2285 @var{org} must be a single hexadecimal integer;
2286 for compatibility with other linkers, you may omit the leading
2287 @samp{0x} usually associated with hexadecimal values. @emph{Note:} there
2288 should be no white space between @var{sectionname}, the equals
2289 sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{org}.
2290
2291 @kindex -Tbss=@var{org}
2292 @kindex -Tdata=@var{org}
2293 @kindex -Ttext=@var{org}
2294 @cindex segment origins, cmd line
2295 @item -Tbss=@var{org}
2296 @itemx -Tdata=@var{org}
2297 @itemx -Ttext=@var{org}
2298 Same as @option{--section-start}, with @code{.bss}, @code{.data} or
2299 @code{.text} as the @var{sectionname}.
2300
2301 @kindex -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
2302 @item -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
2303 @cindex text segment origin, cmd line
2304 When creating an ELF executable, it will set the address of the first
2305 byte of the text segment.
2306
2307 @kindex -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2308 @item -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2309 @cindex rodata segment origin, cmd line
2310 When creating an ELF executable or shared object for a target where
2311 the read-only data is in its own segment separate from the executable
2312 text, it will set the address of the first byte of the read-only data segment.
2313
2314 @kindex -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2315 @item -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2316 @cindex ldata segment origin, cmd line
2317 When creating an ELF executable or shared object for x86-64 medium memory
2318 model, it will set the address of the first byte of the ldata segment.
2319
2320 @kindex --unresolved-symbols
2321 @item --unresolved-symbols=@var{method}
2322 Determine how to handle unresolved symbols. There are four possible
2323 values for @samp{method}:
2324
2325 @table @samp
2326 @item ignore-all
2327 Do not report any unresolved symbols.
2328
2329 @item report-all
2330 Report all unresolved symbols. This is the default.
2331
2332 @item ignore-in-object-files
2333 Report unresolved symbols that are contained in shared libraries, but
2334 ignore them if they come from regular object files.
2335
2336 @item ignore-in-shared-libs
2337 Report unresolved symbols that come from regular object files, but
2338 ignore them if they come from shared libraries. This can be useful
2339 when creating a dynamic binary and it is known that all the shared
2340 libraries that it should be referencing are included on the linker's
2341 command line.
2342 @end table
2343
2344 The behaviour for shared libraries on their own can also be controlled
2345 by the @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} option.
2346
2347 Normally the linker will generate an error message for each reported
2348 unresolved symbol but the option @option{--warn-unresolved-symbols}
2349 can change this to a warning.
2350
2351 @kindex --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2352 @cindex verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2353 @item --dll-verbose
2354 @itemx --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2355 Display the version number for @command{ld} and list the linker emulations
2356 supported. Display which input files can and cannot be opened. Display
2357 the linker script being used by the linker. If the optional @var{NUMBER}
2358 argument > 1, plugin symbol status will also be displayed.
2359
2360 @kindex --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
2361 @cindex version script, symbol versions
2362 @item --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
2363 Specify the name of a version script to the linker. This is typically
2364 used when creating shared libraries to specify additional information
2365 about the version hierarchy for the library being created. This option
2366 is only fully supported on ELF platforms which support shared libraries;
2367 see @ref{VERSION}. It is partially supported on PE platforms, which can
2368 use version scripts to filter symbol visibility in auto-export mode: any
2369 symbols marked @samp{local} in the version script will not be exported.
2370 @xref{WIN32}.
2371
2372 @kindex --warn-common
2373 @cindex warnings, on combining symbols
2374 @cindex combining symbols, warnings on
2375 @item --warn-common
2376 Warn when a common symbol is combined with another common symbol or with
2377 a symbol definition. Unix linkers allow this somewhat sloppy practice,
2378 but linkers on some other operating systems do not. This option allows
2379 you to find potential problems from combining global symbols.
2380 Unfortunately, some C libraries use this practice, so you may get some
2381 warnings about symbols in the libraries as well as in your programs.
2382
2383 There are three kinds of global symbols, illustrated here by C examples:
2384
2385 @table @samp
2386 @item int i = 1;
2387 A definition, which goes in the initialized data section of the output
2388 file.
2389
2390 @item extern int i;
2391 An undefined reference, which does not allocate space.
2392 There must be either a definition or a common symbol for the
2393 variable somewhere.
2394
2395 @item int i;
2396 A common symbol. If there are only (one or more) common symbols for a
2397 variable, it goes in the uninitialized data area of the output file.
2398 The linker merges multiple common symbols for the same variable into a
2399 single symbol. If they are of different sizes, it picks the largest
2400 size. The linker turns a common symbol into a declaration, if there is
2401 a definition of the same variable.
2402 @end table
2403
2404 The @samp{--warn-common} option can produce five kinds of warnings.
2405 Each warning consists of a pair of lines: the first describes the symbol
2406 just encountered, and the second describes the previous symbol
2407 encountered with the same name. One or both of the two symbols will be
2408 a common symbol.
2409
2410 @enumerate
2411 @item
2412 Turning a common symbol into a reference, because there is already a
2413 definition for the symbol.
2414 @smallexample
2415 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2416 overridden by definition
2417 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: defined here
2418 @end smallexample
2419
2420 @item
2421 Turning a common symbol into a reference, because a later definition for
2422 the symbol is encountered. This is the same as the previous case,
2423 except that the symbols are encountered in a different order.
2424 @smallexample
2425 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: definition of `@var{symbol}'
2426 overriding common
2427 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common is here
2428 @end smallexample
2429
2430 @item
2431 Merging a common symbol with a previous same-sized common symbol.
2432 @smallexample
2433 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: multiple common
2434 of `@var{symbol}'
2435 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: previous common is here
2436 @end smallexample
2437
2438 @item
2439 Merging a common symbol with a previous larger common symbol.
2440 @smallexample
2441 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2442 overridden by larger common
2443 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: larger common is here
2444 @end smallexample
2445
2446 @item
2447 Merging a common symbol with a previous smaller common symbol. This is
2448 the same as the previous case, except that the symbols are
2449 encountered in a different order.
2450 @smallexample
2451 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2452 overriding smaller common
2453 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: smaller common is here
2454 @end smallexample
2455 @end enumerate
2456
2457 @kindex --warn-constructors
2458 @item --warn-constructors
2459 Warn if any global constructors are used. This is only useful for a few
2460 object file formats. For formats like COFF or ELF, the linker can not
2461 detect the use of global constructors.
2462
2463 @kindex --warn-multiple-gp
2464 @item --warn-multiple-gp
2465 Warn if multiple global pointer values are required in the output file.
2466 This is only meaningful for certain processors, such as the Alpha.
2467 Specifically, some processors put large-valued constants in a special
2468 section. A special register (the global pointer) points into the middle
2469 of this section, so that constants can be loaded efficiently via a
2470 base-register relative addressing mode. Since the offset in
2471 base-register relative mode is fixed and relatively small (e.g., 16
2472 bits), this limits the maximum size of the constant pool. Thus, in
2473 large programs, it is often necessary to use multiple global pointer
2474 values in order to be able to address all possible constants. This
2475 option causes a warning to be issued whenever this case occurs.
2476
2477 @kindex --warn-once
2478 @cindex warnings, on undefined symbols
2479 @cindex undefined symbols, warnings on
2480 @item --warn-once
2481 Only warn once for each undefined symbol, rather than once per module
2482 which refers to it.
2483
2484 @kindex --warn-section-align
2485 @cindex warnings, on section alignment
2486 @cindex section alignment, warnings on
2487 @item --warn-section-align
2488 Warn if the address of an output section is changed because of
2489 alignment. Typically, the alignment will be set by an input section.
2490 The address will only be changed if it not explicitly specified; that
2491 is, if the @code{SECTIONS} command does not specify a start address for
2492 the section (@pxref{SECTIONS}).
2493
2494 @kindex --warn-textrel
2495 @item --warn-textrel
2496 Warn if the linker adds DT_TEXTREL to a position-independent executable
2497 or shared object.
2498
2499 @kindex --warn-alternate-em
2500 @item --warn-alternate-em
2501 Warn if an object has alternate ELF machine code.
2502
2503 @kindex --warn-unresolved-symbols
2504 @item --warn-unresolved-symbols
2505 If the linker is going to report an unresolved symbol (see the option
2506 @option{--unresolved-symbols}) it will normally generate an error.
2507 This option makes it generate a warning instead.
2508
2509 @kindex --error-unresolved-symbols
2510 @item --error-unresolved-symbols
2511 This restores the linker's default behaviour of generating errors when
2512 it is reporting unresolved symbols.
2513
2514 @kindex --whole-archive
2515 @cindex including an entire archive
2516 @item --whole-archive
2517 For each archive mentioned on the command line after the
2518 @option{--whole-archive} option, include every object file in the archive
2519 in the link, rather than searching the archive for the required object
2520 files. This is normally used to turn an archive file into a shared
2521 library, forcing every object to be included in the resulting shared
2522 library. This option may be used more than once.
2523
2524 Two notes when using this option from gcc: First, gcc doesn't know
2525 about this option, so you have to use @option{-Wl,-whole-archive}.
2526 Second, don't forget to use @option{-Wl,-no-whole-archive} after your
2527 list of archives, because gcc will add its own list of archives to
2528 your link and you may not want this flag to affect those as well.
2529
2530 @kindex --wrap=@var{symbol}
2531 @item --wrap=@var{symbol}
2532 Use a wrapper function for @var{symbol}. Any undefined reference to
2533 @var{symbol} will be resolved to @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. Any
2534 undefined reference to @code{__real_@var{symbol}} will be resolved to
2535 @var{symbol}.
2536
2537 This can be used to provide a wrapper for a system function. The
2538 wrapper function should be called @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. If it
2539 wishes to call the system function, it should call
2540 @code{__real_@var{symbol}}.
2541
2542 Here is a trivial example:
2543
2544 @smallexample
2545 void *
2546 __wrap_malloc (size_t c)
2547 @{
2548 printf ("malloc called with %zu\n", c);
2549 return __real_malloc (c);
2550 @}
2551 @end smallexample
2552
2553 If you link other code with this file using @option{--wrap malloc}, then
2554 all calls to @code{malloc} will call the function @code{__wrap_malloc}
2555 instead. The call to @code{__real_malloc} in @code{__wrap_malloc} will
2556 call the real @code{malloc} function.
2557
2558 You may wish to provide a @code{__real_malloc} function as well, so that
2559 links without the @option{--wrap} option will succeed. If you do this,
2560 you should not put the definition of @code{__real_malloc} in the same
2561 file as @code{__wrap_malloc}; if you do, the assembler may resolve the
2562 call before the linker has a chance to wrap it to @code{malloc}.
2563
2564 Only undefined references are replaced by the linker. So, translation unit
2565 internal references to @var{symbol} are not resolved to
2566 @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. In the next example, the call to @code{f} in
2567 @code{g} is not resolved to @code{__wrap_f}.
2568
2569 @smallexample
2570 int
2571 f (void)
2572 @{
2573 return 123;
2574 @}
2575
2576 int
2577 g (void)
2578 @{
2579 return f();
2580 @}
2581 @end smallexample
2582
2583 @kindex --eh-frame-hdr
2584 @kindex --no-eh-frame-hdr
2585 @item --eh-frame-hdr
2586 @itemx --no-eh-frame-hdr
2587 Request (@option{--eh-frame-hdr}) or suppress
2588 (@option{--no-eh-frame-hdr}) the creation of @code{.eh_frame_hdr}
2589 section and ELF @code{PT_GNU_EH_FRAME} segment header.
2590
2591 @kindex --ld-generated-unwind-info
2592 @item --no-ld-generated-unwind-info
2593 Request creation of @code{.eh_frame} unwind info for linker
2594 generated code sections like PLT. This option is on by default
2595 if linker generated unwind info is supported.
2596
2597 @kindex --enable-new-dtags
2598 @kindex --disable-new-dtags
2599 @item --enable-new-dtags
2600 @itemx --disable-new-dtags
2601 This linker can create the new dynamic tags in ELF. But the older ELF
2602 systems may not understand them. If you specify
2603 @option{--enable-new-dtags}, the new dynamic tags will be created as needed
2604 and older dynamic tags will be omitted.
2605 If you specify @option{--disable-new-dtags}, no new dynamic tags will be
2606 created. By default, the new dynamic tags are not created. Note that
2607 those options are only available for ELF systems.
2608
2609 @kindex --hash-size=@var{number}
2610 @item --hash-size=@var{number}
2611 Set the default size of the linker's hash tables to a prime number
2612 close to @var{number}. Increasing this value can reduce the length of
2613 time it takes the linker to perform its tasks, at the expense of
2614 increasing the linker's memory requirements. Similarly reducing this
2615 value can reduce the memory requirements at the expense of speed.
2616
2617 @kindex --hash-style=@var{style}
2618 @item --hash-style=@var{style}
2619 Set the type of linker's hash table(s). @var{style} can be either
2620 @code{sysv} for classic ELF @code{.hash} section, @code{gnu} for
2621 new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash} section or @code{both} for both
2622 the classic ELF @code{.hash} and new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash}
2623 hash tables. The default depends upon how the linker was configured,
2624 but for most Linux based systems it will be @code{both}.
2625
2626 @kindex --compress-debug-sections=none
2627 @kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2628 @kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2629 @kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
2630 @item --compress-debug-sections=none
2631 @itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2632 @itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2633 @itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
2634 On ELF platforms, these options control how DWARF debug sections are
2635 compressed using zlib.
2636
2637 @option{--compress-debug-sections=none} doesn't compress DWARF debug
2638 sections. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu} compresses
2639 DWARF debug sections and renames them to begin with @samp{.zdebug}
2640 instead of @samp{.debug}. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}
2641 also compresses DWARF debug sections, but rather than renaming them it
2642 sets the SHF_COMPRESSED flag in the sections' headers.
2643
2644 The @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib} option is an alias for
2645 @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}.
2646
2647 Note that this option overrides any compression in input debug
2648 sections, so if a binary is linked with @option{--compress-debug-sections=none}
2649 for example, then any compressed debug sections in input files will be
2650 uncompressed before they are copied into the output binary.
2651
2652 The default compression behaviour varies depending upon the target
2653 involved and the configure options used to build the toolchain. The
2654 default can be determined by examining the output from the linker's
2655 @option{--help} option.
2656
2657 @kindex --reduce-memory-overheads
2658 @item --reduce-memory-overheads
2659 This option reduces memory requirements at ld runtime, at the expense of
2660 linking speed. This was introduced to select the old O(n^2) algorithm
2661 for link map file generation, rather than the new O(n) algorithm which uses
2662 about 40% more memory for symbol storage.
2663
2664 Another effect of the switch is to set the default hash table size to
2665 1021, which again saves memory at the cost of lengthening the linker's
2666 run time. This is not done however if the @option{--hash-size} switch
2667 has been used.
2668
2669 The @option{--reduce-memory-overheads} switch may be also be used to
2670 enable other tradeoffs in future versions of the linker.
2671
2672 @kindex --build-id
2673 @kindex --build-id=@var{style}
2674 @item --build-id
2675 @itemx --build-id=@var{style}
2676 Request the creation of a @code{.note.gnu.build-id} ELF note section
2677 or a @code{.buildid} COFF section. The contents of the note are
2678 unique bits identifying this linked file. @var{style} can be
2679 @code{uuid} to use 128 random bits, @code{sha1} to use a 160-bit
2680 @sc{SHA1} hash on the normative parts of the output contents,
2681 @code{md5} to use a 128-bit @sc{MD5} hash on the normative parts of
2682 the output contents, or @code{0x@var{hexstring}} to use a chosen bit
2683 string specified as an even number of hexadecimal digits (@code{-} and
2684 @code{:} characters between digit pairs are ignored). If @var{style}
2685 is omitted, @code{sha1} is used.
2686
2687 The @code{md5} and @code{sha1} styles produces an identifier
2688 that is always the same in an identical output file, but will be
2689 unique among all nonidentical output files. It is not intended
2690 to be compared as a checksum for the file's contents. A linked
2691 file may be changed later by other tools, but the build ID bit
2692 string identifying the original linked file does not change.
2693
2694 Passing @code{none} for @var{style} disables the setting from any
2695 @code{--build-id} options earlier on the command line.
2696 @end table
2697
2698 @c man end
2699
2700 @subsection Options Specific to i386 PE Targets
2701
2702 @c man begin OPTIONS
2703
2704 The i386 PE linker supports the @option{-shared} option, which causes
2705 the output to be a dynamically linked library (DLL) instead of a
2706 normal executable. You should name the output @code{*.dll} when you
2707 use this option. In addition, the linker fully supports the standard
2708 @code{*.def} files, which may be specified on the linker command line
2709 like an object file (in fact, it should precede archives it exports
2710 symbols from, to ensure that they get linked in, just like a normal
2711 object file).
2712
2713 In addition to the options common to all targets, the i386 PE linker
2714 support additional command-line options that are specific to the i386
2715 PE target. Options that take values may be separated from their
2716 values by either a space or an equals sign.
2717
2718 @table @gcctabopt
2719
2720 @kindex --add-stdcall-alias
2721 @item --add-stdcall-alias
2722 If given, symbols with a stdcall suffix (@@@var{nn}) will be exported
2723 as-is and also with the suffix stripped.
2724 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2725
2726 @kindex --base-file
2727 @item --base-file @var{file}
2728 Use @var{file} as the name of a file in which to save the base
2729 addresses of all the relocations needed for generating DLLs with
2730 @file{dlltool}.
2731 [This is an i386 PE specific option]
2732
2733 @kindex --dll
2734 @item --dll
2735 Create a DLL instead of a regular executable. You may also use
2736 @option{-shared} or specify a @code{LIBRARY} in a given @code{.def}
2737 file.
2738 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2739
2740 @kindex --enable-long-section-names
2741 @kindex --disable-long-section-names
2742 @item --enable-long-section-names
2743 @itemx --disable-long-section-names
2744 The PE variants of the COFF object format add an extension that permits
2745 the use of section names longer than eight characters, the normal limit
2746 for COFF. By default, these names are only allowed in object files, as
2747 fully-linked executable images do not carry the COFF string table required
2748 to support the longer names. As a GNU extension, it is possible to
2749 allow their use in executable images as well, or to (probably pointlessly!)
2750 disallow it in object files, by using these two options. Executable images
2751 generated with these long section names are slightly non-standard, carrying
2752 as they do a string table, and may generate confusing output when examined
2753 with non-GNU PE-aware tools, such as file viewers and dumpers. However,
2754 GDB relies on the use of PE long section names to find Dwarf-2 debug
2755 information sections in an executable image at runtime, and so if neither
2756 option is specified on the command-line, @command{ld} will enable long
2757 section names, overriding the default and technically correct behaviour,
2758 when it finds the presence of debug information while linking an executable
2759 image and not stripping symbols.
2760 [This option is valid for all PE targeted ports of the linker]
2761
2762 @kindex --enable-stdcall-fixup
2763 @kindex --disable-stdcall-fixup
2764 @item --enable-stdcall-fixup
2765 @itemx --disable-stdcall-fixup
2766 If the link finds a symbol that it cannot resolve, it will attempt to
2767 do ``fuzzy linking'' by looking for another defined symbol that differs
2768 only in the format of the symbol name (cdecl vs stdcall) and will
2769 resolve that symbol by linking to the match. For example, the
2770 undefined symbol @code{_foo} might be linked to the function
2771 @code{_foo@@12}, or the undefined symbol @code{_bar@@16} might be linked
2772 to the function @code{_bar}. When the linker does this, it prints a
2773 warning, since it normally should have failed to link, but sometimes
2774 import libraries generated from third-party dlls may need this feature
2775 to be usable. If you specify @option{--enable-stdcall-fixup}, this
2776 feature is fully enabled and warnings are not printed. If you specify
2777 @option{--disable-stdcall-fixup}, this feature is disabled and such
2778 mismatches are considered to be errors.
2779 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2780
2781 @kindex --leading-underscore
2782 @kindex --no-leading-underscore
2783 @item --leading-underscore
2784 @itemx --no-leading-underscore
2785 For most targets default symbol-prefix is an underscore and is defined
2786 in target's description. By this option it is possible to
2787 disable/enable the default underscore symbol-prefix.
2788
2789 @cindex DLLs, creating
2790 @kindex --export-all-symbols
2791 @item --export-all-symbols
2792 If given, all global symbols in the objects used to build a DLL will
2793 be exported by the DLL. Note that this is the default if there
2794 otherwise wouldn't be any exported symbols. When symbols are
2795 explicitly exported via DEF files or implicitly exported via function
2796 attributes, the default is to not export anything else unless this
2797 option is given. Note that the symbols @code{DllMain@@12},
2798 @code{DllEntryPoint@@0}, @code{DllMainCRTStartup@@12}, and
2799 @code{impure_ptr} will not be automatically
2800 exported. Also, symbols imported from other DLLs will not be
2801 re-exported, nor will symbols specifying the DLL's internal layout
2802 such as those beginning with @code{_head_} or ending with
2803 @code{_iname}. In addition, no symbols from @code{libgcc},
2804 @code{libstd++}, @code{libmingw32}, or @code{crtX.o} will be exported.
2805 Symbols whose names begin with @code{__rtti_} or @code{__builtin_} will
2806 not be exported, to help with C++ DLLs. Finally, there is an
2807 extensive list of cygwin-private symbols that are not exported
2808 (obviously, this applies on when building DLLs for cygwin targets).
2809 These cygwin-excludes are: @code{_cygwin_dll_entry@@12},
2810 @code{_cygwin_crt0_common@@8}, @code{_cygwin_noncygwin_dll_entry@@12},
2811 @code{_fmode}, @code{_impure_ptr}, @code{cygwin_attach_dll},
2812 @code{cygwin_premain0}, @code{cygwin_premain1}, @code{cygwin_premain2},
2813 @code{cygwin_premain3}, and @code{environ}.
2814 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2815
2816 @kindex --exclude-symbols
2817 @item --exclude-symbols @var{symbol},@var{symbol},...
2818 Specifies a list of symbols which should not be automatically
2819 exported. The symbol names may be delimited by commas or colons.
2820 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2821
2822 @kindex --exclude-all-symbols
2823 @item --exclude-all-symbols
2824 Specifies no symbols should be automatically exported.
2825 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2826
2827 @kindex --file-alignment
2828 @item --file-alignment
2829 Specify the file alignment. Sections in the file will always begin at
2830 file offsets which are multiples of this number. This defaults to
2831 512.
2832 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2833
2834 @cindex heap size
2835 @kindex --heap
2836 @item --heap @var{reserve}
2837 @itemx --heap @var{reserve},@var{commit}
2838 Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
2839 to be used as heap for this program. The default is 1MB reserved, 4K
2840 committed.
2841 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2842
2843 @cindex image base
2844 @kindex --image-base
2845 @item --image-base @var{value}
2846 Use @var{value} as the base address of your program or dll. This is
2847 the lowest memory location that will be used when your program or dll
2848 is loaded. To reduce the need to relocate and improve performance of
2849 your dlls, each should have a unique base address and not overlap any
2850 other dlls. The default is 0x400000 for executables, and 0x10000000
2851 for dlls.
2852 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2853
2854 @kindex --kill-at
2855 @item --kill-at
2856 If given, the stdcall suffixes (@@@var{nn}) will be stripped from
2857 symbols before they are exported.
2858 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2859
2860 @kindex --large-address-aware
2861 @item --large-address-aware
2862 If given, the appropriate bit in the ``Characteristics'' field of the COFF
2863 header is set to indicate that this executable supports virtual addresses
2864 greater than 2 gigabytes. This should be used in conjunction with the /3GB
2865 or /USERVA=@var{value} megabytes switch in the ``[operating systems]''
2866 section of the BOOT.INI. Otherwise, this bit has no effect.
2867 [This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
2868
2869 @kindex --disable-large-address-aware
2870 @item --disable-large-address-aware
2871 Reverts the effect of a previous @samp{--large-address-aware} option.
2872 This is useful if @samp{--large-address-aware} is always set by the compiler
2873 driver (e.g. Cygwin gcc) and the executable does not support virtual
2874 addresses greater than 2 gigabytes.
2875 [This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
2876
2877 @kindex --major-image-version
2878 @item --major-image-version @var{value}
2879 Sets the major number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 1.
2880 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2881
2882 @kindex --major-os-version
2883 @item --major-os-version @var{value}
2884 Sets the major number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 4.
2885 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2886
2887 @kindex --major-subsystem-version
2888 @item --major-subsystem-version @var{value}
2889 Sets the major number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 4.
2890 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2891
2892 @kindex --minor-image-version
2893 @item --minor-image-version @var{value}
2894 Sets the minor number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 0.
2895 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2896
2897 @kindex --minor-os-version
2898 @item --minor-os-version @var{value}
2899 Sets the minor number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 0.
2900 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2901
2902 @kindex --minor-subsystem-version
2903 @item --minor-subsystem-version @var{value}
2904 Sets the minor number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 0.
2905 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2906
2907 @cindex DEF files, creating
2908 @cindex DLLs, creating
2909 @kindex --output-def
2910 @item --output-def @var{file}
2911 The linker will create the file @var{file} which will contain a DEF
2912 file corresponding to the DLL the linker is generating. This DEF file
2913 (which should be called @code{*.def}) may be used to create an import
2914 library with @code{dlltool} or may be used as a reference to
2915 automatically or implicitly exported symbols.
2916 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2917
2918 @cindex DLLs, creating
2919 @kindex --enable-auto-image-base
2920 @item --enable-auto-image-base
2921 @itemx --enable-auto-image-base=@var{value}
2922 Automatically choose the image base for DLLs, optionally starting with base
2923 @var{value}, unless one is specified using the @code{--image-base} argument.
2924 By using a hash generated from the dllname to create unique image bases
2925 for each DLL, in-memory collisions and relocations which can delay program
2926 execution are avoided.
2927 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2928
2929 @kindex --disable-auto-image-base
2930 @item --disable-auto-image-base
2931 Do not automatically generate a unique image base. If there is no
2932 user-specified image base (@code{--image-base}) then use the platform
2933 default.
2934 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2935
2936 @cindex DLLs, linking to
2937 @kindex --dll-search-prefix
2938 @item --dll-search-prefix @var{string}
2939 When linking dynamically to a dll without an import library,
2940 search for @code{<string><basename>.dll} in preference to
2941 @code{lib<basename>.dll}. This behaviour allows easy distinction
2942 between DLLs built for the various "subplatforms": native, cygwin,
2943 uwin, pw, etc. For instance, cygwin DLLs typically use
2944 @code{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}.
2945 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2946
2947 @kindex --enable-auto-import
2948 @item --enable-auto-import
2949 Do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to @code{__imp__symbol} for
2950 DATA imports from DLLs, thus making it possible to bypass the dllimport
2951 mechanism on the user side and to reference unmangled symbol names.
2952 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2953
2954 The following remarks pertain to the original implementation of the
2955 feature and are obsolete nowadays for Cygwin and MinGW targets.
2956
2957 Note: Use of the 'auto-import' extension will cause the text section
2958 of the image file to be made writable. This does not conform to the
2959 PE-COFF format specification published by Microsoft.
2960
2961 Note - use of the 'auto-import' extension will also cause read only
2962 data which would normally be placed into the .rdata section to be
2963 placed into the .data section instead. This is in order to work
2964 around a problem with consts that is described here:
2965 http://www.cygwin.com/ml/cygwin/2004-09/msg01101.html
2966
2967 Using 'auto-import' generally will 'just work' -- but sometimes you may
2968 see this message:
2969
2970 "variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
2971 documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
2972
2973 This message occurs when some (sub)expression accesses an address
2974 ultimately given by the sum of two constants (Win32 import tables only
2975 allow one). Instances where this may occur include accesses to member
2976 fields of struct variables imported from a DLL, as well as using a
2977 constant index into an array variable imported from a DLL. Any
2978 multiword variable (arrays, structs, long long, etc) may trigger
2979 this error condition. However, regardless of the exact data type
2980 of the offending exported variable, ld will always detect it, issue
2981 the warning, and exit.
2982
2983 There are several ways to address this difficulty, regardless of the
2984 data type of the exported variable:
2985
2986 One way is to use --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc switch. This leaves the task
2987 of adjusting references in your client code for runtime environment, so
2988 this method works only when runtime environment supports this feature.
2989
2990 A second solution is to force one of the 'constants' to be a variable --
2991 that is, unknown and un-optimizable at compile time. For arrays,
2992 there are two possibilities: a) make the indexee (the array's address)
2993 a variable, or b) make the 'constant' index a variable. Thus:
2994
2995 @example
2996 extern type extern_array[];
2997 extern_array[1] -->
2998 @{ volatile type *t=extern_array; t[1] @}
2999 @end example
3000
3001 or
3002
3003 @example
3004 extern type extern_array[];
3005 extern_array[1] -->
3006 @{ volatile int t=1; extern_array[t] @}
3007 @end example
3008
3009 For structs (and most other multiword data types) the only option
3010 is to make the struct itself (or the long long, or the ...) variable:
3011
3012 @example
3013 extern struct s extern_struct;
3014 extern_struct.field -->
3015 @{ volatile struct s *t=&extern_struct; t->field @}
3016 @end example
3017
3018 or
3019
3020 @example
3021 extern long long extern_ll;
3022 extern_ll -->
3023 @{ volatile long long * local_ll=&extern_ll; *local_ll @}
3024 @end example
3025
3026 A third method of dealing with this difficulty is to abandon
3027 'auto-import' for the offending symbol and mark it with
3028 @code{__declspec(dllimport)}. However, in practice that
3029 requires using compile-time #defines to indicate whether you are
3030 building a DLL, building client code that will link to the DLL, or
3031 merely building/linking to a static library. In making the choice
3032 between the various methods of resolving the 'direct address with
3033 constant offset' problem, you should consider typical real-world usage:
3034
3035 Original:
3036 @example
3037 --foo.h
3038 extern int arr[];
3039 --foo.c
3040 #include "foo.h"
3041 void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3042 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3043 @}
3044 @end example
3045
3046 Solution 1:
3047 @example
3048 --foo.h
3049 extern int arr[];
3050 --foo.c
3051 #include "foo.h"
3052 void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3053 /* This workaround is for win32 and cygwin; do not "optimize" */
3054 volatile int *parr = arr;
3055 printf("%d\n",parr[1]);
3056 @}
3057 @end example
3058
3059 Solution 2:
3060 @example
3061 --foo.h
3062 /* Note: auto-export is assumed (no __declspec(dllexport)) */
3063 #if (defined(_WIN32) || defined(__CYGWIN__)) && \
3064 !(defined(FOO_BUILD_DLL) || defined(FOO_STATIC))
3065 #define FOO_IMPORT __declspec(dllimport)
3066 #else
3067 #define FOO_IMPORT
3068 #endif
3069 extern FOO_IMPORT int arr[];
3070 --foo.c
3071 #include "foo.h"
3072 void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3073 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3074 @}
3075 @end example
3076
3077 A fourth way to avoid this problem is to re-code your
3078 library to use a functional interface rather than a data interface
3079 for the offending variables (e.g. set_foo() and get_foo() accessor
3080 functions).
3081
3082 @kindex --disable-auto-import
3083 @item --disable-auto-import
3084 Do not attempt to do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to
3085 @code{__imp__symbol} for DATA imports from DLLs.
3086 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3087
3088 @kindex --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3089 @item --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3090 If your code contains expressions described in --enable-auto-import section,
3091 that is, DATA imports from DLL with non-zero offset, this switch will create
3092 a vector of 'runtime pseudo relocations' which can be used by runtime
3093 environment to adjust references to such data in your client code.
3094 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3095
3096 @kindex --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3097 @item --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3098 Do not create pseudo relocations for non-zero offset DATA imports from DLLs.
3099 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3100
3101 @kindex --enable-extra-pe-debug
3102 @item --enable-extra-pe-debug
3103 Show additional debug info related to auto-import symbol thunking.
3104 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3105
3106 @kindex --section-alignment
3107 @item --section-alignment
3108 Sets the section alignment. Sections in memory will always begin at
3109 addresses which are a multiple of this number. Defaults to 0x1000.
3110 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3111
3112 @cindex stack size
3113 @kindex --stack
3114 @item --stack @var{reserve}
3115 @itemx --stack @var{reserve},@var{commit}
3116 Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
3117 to be used as stack for this program. The default is 2MB reserved, 4K
3118 committed.
3119 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3120
3121 @kindex --subsystem
3122 @item --subsystem @var{which}
3123 @itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}
3124 @itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}.@var{minor}
3125 Specifies the subsystem under which your program will execute. The
3126 legal values for @var{which} are @code{native}, @code{windows},
3127 @code{console}, @code{posix}, and @code{xbox}. You may optionally set
3128 the subsystem version also. Numeric values are also accepted for
3129 @var{which}.
3130 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3131
3132 The following options set flags in the @code{DllCharacteristics} field
3133 of the PE file header:
3134 [These options are specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3135
3136 @kindex --high-entropy-va
3137 @item --high-entropy-va
3138 @itemx --disable-high-entropy-va
3139 Image is compatible with 64-bit address space layout randomization
3140 (ASLR). This option is enabled by default for 64-bit PE images.
3141
3142 This option also implies @option{--dynamicbase} and
3143 @option{--enable-reloc-section}.
3144
3145 @kindex --dynamicbase
3146 @item --dynamicbase
3147 @itemx --disable-dynamicbase
3148 The image base address may be relocated using address space layout
3149 randomization (ASLR). This feature was introduced with MS Windows
3150 Vista for i386 PE targets. This option is enabled by default but
3151 can be disabled via the @option{--disable-dynamicbase} option.
3152 This option also implies @option{--enable-reloc-section}.
3153
3154 @kindex --forceinteg
3155 @item --forceinteg
3156 @itemx --disable-forceinteg
3157 Code integrity checks are enforced. This option is disabled by
3158 default.
3159
3160 @kindex --nxcompat
3161 @item --nxcompat
3162 @item --disable-nxcompat
3163 The image is compatible with the Data Execution Prevention.
3164 This feature was introduced with MS Windows XP SP2 for i386 PE
3165 targets. The option is enabled by default.
3166
3167 @kindex --no-isolation
3168 @item --no-isolation
3169 @itemx --disable-no-isolation
3170 Although the image understands isolation, do not isolate the image.
3171 This option is disabled by default.
3172
3173 @kindex --no-seh
3174 @item --no-seh
3175 @itemx --disable-no-seh
3176 The image does not use SEH. No SE handler may be called from
3177 this image. This option is disabled by default.
3178
3179 @kindex --no-bind
3180 @item --no-bind
3181 @itemx --disable-no-bind
3182 Do not bind this image. This option is disabled by default.
3183
3184 @kindex --wdmdriver
3185 @item --wdmdriver
3186 @itemx --disable-wdmdriver
3187 The driver uses the MS Windows Driver Model. This option is disabled
3188 by default.
3189
3190 @kindex --tsaware
3191 @item --tsaware
3192 @itemx --disable-tsaware
3193 The image is Terminal Server aware. This option is disabled by
3194 default.
3195
3196 @kindex --insert-timestamp
3197 @item --insert-timestamp
3198 @itemx --no-insert-timestamp
3199 Insert a real timestamp into the image. This is the default behaviour
3200 as it matches legacy code and it means that the image will work with
3201 other, proprietary tools. The problem with this default is that it
3202 will result in slightly different images being produced each time the
3203 same sources are linked. The option @option{--no-insert-timestamp}
3204 can be used to insert a zero value for the timestamp, this ensuring
3205 that binaries produced from identical sources will compare
3206 identically.
3207
3208 @kindex --enable-reloc-section
3209 @item --enable-reloc-section
3210 @itemx --disable-reloc-section
3211 Create the base relocation table, which is necessary if the image
3212 is loaded at a different image base than specified in the PE header.
3213 This option is enabled by default.
3214 @end table
3215
3216 @c man end
3217
3218 @ifset C6X
3219 @subsection Options specific to C6X uClinux targets
3220
3221 @c man begin OPTIONS
3222
3223 The C6X uClinux target uses a binary format called DSBT to support shared
3224 libraries. Each shared library in the system needs to have a unique index;
3225 all executables use an index of 0.
3226
3227 @table @gcctabopt
3228
3229 @kindex --dsbt-size
3230 @item --dsbt-size @var{size}
3231 This option sets the number of entries in the DSBT of the current executable
3232 or shared library to @var{size}. The default is to create a table with 64
3233 entries.
3234
3235 @kindex --dsbt-index
3236 @item --dsbt-index @var{index}
3237 This option sets the DSBT index of the current executable or shared library
3238 to @var{index}. The default is 0, which is appropriate for generating
3239 executables. If a shared library is generated with a DSBT index of 0, the
3240 @code{R_C6000_DSBT_INDEX} relocs are copied into the output file.
3241
3242 @kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
3243 The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent
3244 exidx entries in frame unwind info.
3245
3246 @end table
3247
3248 @c man end
3249 @end ifset
3250
3251 @ifset CSKY
3252 @subsection Options specific to C-SKY targets
3253
3254 @c man begin OPTIONS
3255
3256 @table @gcctabopt
3257
3258 @kindex --branch-stub on C-SKY
3259 @item --branch-stub
3260 This option enables linker branch relaxation by inserting branch stub
3261 sections when needed to extend the range of branches. This option is
3262 usually not required since C-SKY supports branch and call instructions that
3263 can access the full memory range and branch relaxation is normally handled by
3264 the compiler or assembler.
3265
3266 @kindex --stub-group-size on C-SKY
3267 @item --stub-group-size=@var{N}
3268 This option allows finer control of linker branch stub creation.
3269 It sets the maximum size of a group of input sections that can
3270 be handled by one stub section. A negative value of @var{N} locates
3271 stub sections after their branches, while a positive value allows stub
3272 sections to appear either before or after the branches. Values of
3273 @samp{1} or @samp{-1} indicate that the
3274 linker should choose suitable defaults.
3275
3276 @end table
3277
3278 @c man end
3279 @end ifset
3280
3281 @ifset M68HC11
3282 @subsection Options specific to Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 targets
3283
3284 @c man begin OPTIONS
3285
3286 The 68HC11 and 68HC12 linkers support specific options to control the
3287 memory bank switching mapping and trampoline code generation.
3288
3289 @table @gcctabopt
3290
3291 @kindex --no-trampoline
3292 @item --no-trampoline
3293 This option disables the generation of trampoline. By default a trampoline
3294 is generated for each far function which is called using a @code{jsr}
3295 instruction (this happens when a pointer to a far function is taken).
3296
3297 @kindex --bank-window
3298 @item --bank-window @var{name}
3299 This option indicates to the linker the name of the memory region in
3300 the @samp{MEMORY} specification that describes the memory bank window.
3301 The definition of such region is then used by the linker to compute
3302 paging and addresses within the memory window.
3303
3304 @end table
3305
3306 @c man end
3307 @end ifset
3308
3309 @ifset M68K
3310 @subsection Options specific to Motorola 68K target
3311
3312 @c man begin OPTIONS
3313
3314 The following options are supported to control handling of GOT generation
3315 when linking for 68K targets.
3316
3317 @table @gcctabopt
3318
3319 @kindex --got
3320 @item --got=@var{type}
3321 This option tells the linker which GOT generation scheme to use.
3322 @var{type} should be one of @samp{single}, @samp{negative},
3323 @samp{multigot} or @samp{target}. For more information refer to the
3324 Info entry for @file{ld}.
3325
3326 @end table
3327
3328 @c man end
3329 @end ifset
3330
3331 @ifset MIPS
3332 @subsection Options specific to MIPS targets
3333
3334 @c man begin OPTIONS
3335
3336 The following options are supported to control microMIPS instruction
3337 generation and branch relocation checks for ISA mode transitions when
3338 linking for MIPS targets.
3339
3340 @table @gcctabopt
3341
3342 @kindex --insn32
3343 @item --insn32
3344 @kindex --no-insn32
3345 @itemx --no-insn32
3346 These options control the choice of microMIPS instructions used in code
3347 generated by the linker, such as that in the PLT or lazy binding stubs,
3348 or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is used, then the linker only uses
3349 32-bit instruction encodings. By default or if @samp{--no-insn32} is
3350 used, all instruction encodings are used, including 16-bit ones where
3351 possible.
3352
3353 @kindex --ignore-branch-isa
3354 @item --ignore-branch-isa
3355 @kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
3356 @itemx --no-ignore-branch-isa
3357 These options control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode
3358 transitions. If @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker
3359 accepts any branch relocations and any ISA mode transition required
3360 is lost in relocation calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL}
3361 instructions which meet relaxation conditions and are converted to
3362 equivalent @code{JALX} instructions as the associated relocation is
3363 calculated. By default or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used
3364 a check is made causing the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce
3365 an error.
3366
3367 @kindex --compact-branches
3368 @item --compact-branches
3369 @kindex --no-compact-branches
3370 @itemx --no-compact-branches
3371 These options control the generation of compact instructions by the linker
3372 in the PLT entries for MIPS R6.
3373
3374 @end table
3375
3376 @c man end
3377 @end ifset
3378
3379
3380 @ifset PDP11
3381 @subsection Options specific to PDP11 targets
3382
3383 @c man begin OPTIONS
3384
3385 For the pdp11-aout target, three variants of the output format can be
3386 produced as selected by the following options. The default variant
3387 for pdp11-aout is the @samp{--omagic} option, whereas for other
3388 targets @samp{--nmagic} is the default. The @samp{--imagic} option is
3389 defined only for the pdp11-aout target, while the others are described
3390 here as they apply to the pdp11-aout target.
3391
3392 @table @gcctabopt
3393
3394 @kindex -N
3395 @item -N
3396 @kindex --omagic
3397 @itemx --omagic
3398
3399 Mark the output as @code{OMAGIC} (0407) in the @file{a.out} header to
3400 indicate that the text segment is not to be write-protected and
3401 shared. Since the text and data sections are both readable and
3402 writable, the data section is allocated immediately contiguous after
3403 the text segment. This is the oldest format for PDP11 executable
3404 programs and is the default for @command{ld} on PDP11 Unix systems
3405 from the beginning through 2.11BSD.
3406
3407 @kindex -n
3408 @item -n
3409 @kindex --nmagic
3410 @itemx --nmagic
3411
3412 Mark the output as @code{NMAGIC} (0410) in the @file{a.out} header to
3413 indicate that when the output file is executed, the text portion will
3414 be read-only and shareable among all processes executing the same
3415 file. This involves moving the data areas up to the first possible 8K
3416 byte page boundary following the end of the text. This option creates
3417 a @emph{pure executable} format.
3418
3419 @kindex -z
3420 @item -z
3421 @kindex --imagic
3422 @itemx --imagic
3423
3424 Mark the output as @code{IMAGIC} (0411) in the @file{a.out} header to
3425 indicate that when the output file is executed, the program text and
3426 data areas will be loaded into separate address spaces using the split
3427 instruction and data space feature of the memory management unit in
3428 larger models of the PDP11. This doubles the address space available
3429 to the program. The text segment is again pure, write-protected, and
3430 shareable. The only difference in the output format between this
3431 option and the others, besides the magic number, is that both the text
3432 and data sections start at location 0. The @samp{-z} option selected
3433 this format in 2.11BSD. This option creates a @emph{separate
3434 executable} format.
3435
3436 @kindex --no-omagic
3437 @item --no-omagic
3438
3439 Equivalent to @samp{--nmagic} for pdp11-aout.
3440
3441 @end table
3442
3443 @c man end
3444 @end ifset
3445
3446 @ifset UsesEnvVars
3447 @node Environment
3448 @section Environment Variables
3449
3450 @c man begin ENVIRONMENT
3451
3452 You can change the behaviour of @command{ld} with the environment variables
3453 @ifclear SingleFormat
3454 @code{GNUTARGET},
3455 @end ifclear
3456 @code{LDEMULATION} and @code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}.
3457
3458 @ifclear SingleFormat
3459 @kindex GNUTARGET
3460 @cindex default input format
3461 @code{GNUTARGET} determines the input-file object format if you don't
3462 use @samp{-b} (or its synonym @samp{--format}). Its value should be one
3463 of the BFD names for an input format (@pxref{BFD}). If there is no
3464 @code{GNUTARGET} in the environment, @command{ld} uses the natural format
3465 of the target. If @code{GNUTARGET} is set to @code{default} then BFD
3466 attempts to discover the input format by examining binary input files;
3467 this method often succeeds, but there are potential ambiguities, since
3468 there is no method of ensuring that the magic number used to specify
3469 object-file formats is unique. However, the configuration procedure for
3470 BFD on each system places the conventional format for that system first
3471 in the search-list, so ambiguities are resolved in favor of convention.
3472 @end ifclear
3473
3474 @kindex LDEMULATION
3475 @cindex default emulation
3476 @cindex emulation, default
3477 @code{LDEMULATION} determines the default emulation if you don't use the
3478 @samp{-m} option. The emulation can affect various aspects of linker
3479 behaviour, particularly the default linker script. You can list the
3480 available emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options. If
3481 the @samp{-m} option is not used, and the @code{LDEMULATION} environment
3482 variable is not defined, the default emulation depends upon how the
3483 linker was configured.
3484
3485 @kindex COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE
3486 @cindex demangling, default
3487 Normally, the linker will default to demangling symbols. However, if
3488 @code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE} is set in the environment, then it will
3489 default to not demangling symbols. This environment variable is used in
3490 a similar fashion by the @code{gcc} linker wrapper program. The default
3491 may be overridden by the @samp{--demangle} and @samp{--no-demangle}
3492 options.
3493
3494 @c man end
3495 @end ifset
3496
3497 @node Scripts
3498 @chapter Linker Scripts
3499
3500 @cindex scripts
3501 @cindex linker scripts
3502 @cindex command files
3503 Every link is controlled by a @dfn{linker script}. This script is
3504 written in the linker command language.
3505
3506 The main purpose of the linker script is to describe how the sections in
3507 the input files should be mapped into the output file, and to control
3508 the memory layout of the output file. Most linker scripts do nothing
3509 more than this. However, when necessary, the linker script can also
3510 direct the linker to perform many other operations, using the commands
3511 described below.
3512
3513 The linker always uses a linker script. If you do not supply one
3514 yourself, the linker will use a default script that is compiled into the
3515 linker executable. You can use the @samp{--verbose} command-line option
3516 to display the default linker script. Certain command-line options,
3517 such as @samp{-r} or @samp{-N}, will affect the default linker script.
3518
3519 You may supply your own linker script by using the @samp{-T} command
3520 line option. When you do this, your linker script will replace the
3521 default linker script.
3522
3523 You may also use linker scripts implicitly by naming them as input files
3524 to the linker, as though they were files to be linked. @xref{Implicit
3525 Linker Scripts}.
3526
3527 @menu
3528 * Basic Script Concepts:: Basic Linker Script Concepts
3529 * Script Format:: Linker Script Format
3530 * Simple Example:: Simple Linker Script Example
3531 * Simple Commands:: Simple Linker Script Commands
3532 * Assignments:: Assigning Values to Symbols
3533 * SECTIONS:: SECTIONS Command
3534 * MEMORY:: MEMORY Command
3535 * PHDRS:: PHDRS Command
3536 * VERSION:: VERSION Command
3537 * Expressions:: Expressions in Linker Scripts
3538 * Implicit Linker Scripts:: Implicit Linker Scripts
3539 @end menu
3540
3541 @node Basic Script Concepts
3542 @section Basic Linker Script Concepts
3543 @cindex linker script concepts
3544 We need to define some basic concepts and vocabulary in order to
3545 describe the linker script language.
3546
3547 The linker combines input files into a single output file. The output
3548 file and each input file are in a special data format known as an
3549 @dfn{object file format}. Each file is called an @dfn{object file}.
3550 The output file is often called an @dfn{executable}, but for our
3551 purposes we will also call it an object file. Each object file has,
3552 among other things, a list of @dfn{sections}. We sometimes refer to a
3553 section in an input file as an @dfn{input section}; similarly, a section
3554 in the output file is an @dfn{output section}.
3555
3556 Each section in an object file has a name and a size. Most sections
3557 also have an associated block of data, known as the @dfn{section
3558 contents}. A section may be marked as @dfn{loadable}, which means that
3559 the contents should be loaded into memory when the output file is run.
3560 A section with no contents may be @dfn{allocatable}, which means that an
3561 area in memory should be set aside, but nothing in particular should be
3562 loaded there (in some cases this memory must be zeroed out). A section
3563 which is neither loadable nor allocatable typically contains some sort
3564 of debugging information.
3565
3566 Every loadable or allocatable output section has two addresses. The
3567 first is the @dfn{VMA}, or virtual memory address. This is the address
3568 the section will have when the output file is run. The second is the
3569 @dfn{LMA}, or load memory address. This is the address at which the
3570 section will be loaded. In most cases the two addresses will be the
3571 same. An example of when they might be different is when a data section
3572 is loaded into ROM, and then copied into RAM when the program starts up
3573 (this technique is often used to initialize global variables in a ROM
3574 based system). In this case the ROM address would be the LMA, and the
3575 RAM address would be the VMA.
3576
3577 You can see the sections in an object file by using the @code{objdump}
3578 program with the @samp{-h} option.
3579
3580 Every object file also has a list of @dfn{symbols}, known as the
3581 @dfn{symbol table}. A symbol may be defined or undefined. Each symbol
3582 has a name, and each defined symbol has an address, among other
3583 information. If you compile a C or C++ program into an object file, you
3584 will get a defined symbol for every defined function and global or
3585 static variable. Every undefined function or global variable which is
3586 referenced in the input file will become an undefined symbol.
3587
3588 You can see the symbols in an object file by using the @code{nm}
3589 program, or by using the @code{objdump} program with the @samp{-t}
3590 option.
3591
3592 @node Script Format
3593 @section Linker Script Format
3594 @cindex linker script format
3595 Linker scripts are text files.
3596
3597 You write a linker script as a series of commands. Each command is
3598 either a keyword, possibly followed by arguments, or an assignment to a
3599 symbol. You may separate commands using semicolons. Whitespace is
3600 generally ignored.
3601
3602 Strings such as file or format names can normally be entered directly.
3603 If the file name contains a character such as a comma which would
3604 otherwise serve to separate file names, you may put the file name in
3605 double quotes. There is no way to use a double quote character in a
3606 file name.
3607
3608 You may include comments in linker scripts just as in C, delimited by
3609 @samp{/*} and @samp{*/}. As in C, comments are syntactically equivalent
3610 to whitespace.
3611
3612 @node Simple Example
3613 @section Simple Linker Script Example
3614 @cindex linker script example
3615 @cindex example of linker script
3616 Many linker scripts are fairly simple.
3617
3618 The simplest possible linker script has just one command:
3619 @samp{SECTIONS}. You use the @samp{SECTIONS} command to describe the
3620 memory layout of the output file.
3621
3622 The @samp{SECTIONS} command is a powerful command. Here we will
3623 describe a simple use of it. Let's assume your program consists only of
3624 code, initialized data, and uninitialized data. These will be in the
3625 @samp{.text}, @samp{.data}, and @samp{.bss} sections, respectively.
3626 Let's assume further that these are the only sections which appear in
3627 your input files.
3628
3629 For this example, let's say that the code should be loaded at address
3630 0x10000, and that the data should start at address 0x8000000. Here is a
3631 linker script which will do that:
3632 @smallexample
3633 SECTIONS
3634 @{
3635 . = 0x10000;
3636 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
3637 . = 0x8000000;
3638 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
3639 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
3640 @}
3641 @end smallexample
3642
3643 You write the @samp{SECTIONS} command as the keyword @samp{SECTIONS},
3644 followed by a series of symbol assignments and output section
3645 descriptions enclosed in curly braces.
3646
3647 The first line inside the @samp{SECTIONS} command of the above example
3648 sets the value of the special symbol @samp{.}, which is the location
3649 counter. If you do not specify the address of an output section in some
3650 other way (other ways are described later), the address is set from the
3651 current value of the location counter. The location counter is then
3652 incremented by the size of the output section. At the start of the
3653 @samp{SECTIONS} command, the location counter has the value @samp{0}.
3654
3655 The second line defines an output section, @samp{.text}. The colon is
3656 required syntax which may be ignored for now. Within the curly braces
3657 after the output section name, you list the names of the input sections
3658 which should be placed into this output section. The @samp{*} is a
3659 wildcard which matches any file name. The expression @samp{*(.text)}
3660 means all @samp{.text} input sections in all input files.
3661
3662 Since the location counter is @samp{0x10000} when the output section
3663 @samp{.text} is defined, the linker will set the address of the
3664 @samp{.text} section in the output file to be @samp{0x10000}.
3665
3666 The remaining lines define the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss} sections in
3667 the output file. The linker will place the @samp{.data} output section
3668 at address @samp{0x8000000}. After the linker places the @samp{.data}
3669 output section, the value of the location counter will be
3670 @samp{0x8000000} plus the size of the @samp{.data} output section. The
3671 effect is that the linker will place the @samp{.bss} output section
3672 immediately after the @samp{.data} output section in memory.
3673
3674 The linker will ensure that each output section has the required
3675 alignment, by increasing the location counter if necessary. In this
3676 example, the specified addresses for the @samp{.text} and @samp{.data}
3677 sections will probably satisfy any alignment constraints, but the linker
3678 may have to create a small gap between the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss}
3679 sections.
3680
3681 That's it! That's a simple and complete linker script.
3682
3683 @node Simple Commands
3684 @section Simple Linker Script Commands
3685 @cindex linker script simple commands
3686 In this section we describe the simple linker script commands.
3687
3688 @menu
3689 * Entry Point:: Setting the entry point
3690 * File Commands:: Commands dealing with files
3691 @ifclear SingleFormat
3692 * Format Commands:: Commands dealing with object file formats
3693 @end ifclear
3694
3695 * REGION_ALIAS:: Assign alias names to memory regions
3696 * Miscellaneous Commands:: Other linker script commands
3697 @end menu
3698
3699 @node Entry Point
3700 @subsection Setting the Entry Point
3701 @kindex ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3702 @cindex start of execution
3703 @cindex first instruction
3704 @cindex entry point
3705 The first instruction to execute in a program is called the @dfn{entry
3706 point}. You can use the @code{ENTRY} linker script command to set the
3707 entry point. The argument is a symbol name:
3708 @smallexample
3709 ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3710 @end smallexample
3711
3712 There are several ways to set the entry point. The linker will set the
3713 entry point by trying each of the following methods in order, and
3714 stopping when one of them succeeds:
3715 @itemize @bullet
3716 @item
3717 the @samp{-e} @var{entry} command-line option;
3718 @item
3719 the @code{ENTRY(@var{symbol})} command in a linker script;
3720 @item
3721 the value of a target-specific symbol, if it is defined; For many
3722 targets this is @code{start}, but PE- and BeOS-based systems for example
3723 check a list of possible entry symbols, matching the first one found.
3724 @item
3725 the address of the first byte of the @samp{.text} section, if present;
3726 @item
3727 The address @code{0}.
3728 @end itemize
3729
3730 @node File Commands
3731 @subsection Commands Dealing with Files
3732 @cindex linker script file commands
3733 Several linker script commands deal with files.
3734
3735 @table @code
3736 @item INCLUDE @var{filename}
3737 @kindex INCLUDE @var{filename}
3738 @cindex including a linker script
3739 Include the linker script @var{filename} at this point. The file will
3740 be searched for in the current directory, and in any directory specified
3741 with the @option{-L} option. You can nest calls to @code{INCLUDE} up to
3742 10 levels deep.
3743
3744 You can place @code{INCLUDE} directives at the top level, in @code{MEMORY} or
3745 @code{SECTIONS} commands, or in output section descriptions.
3746
3747 @item INPUT(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3748 @itemx INPUT(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3749 @kindex INPUT(@var{files})
3750 @cindex input files in linker scripts
3751 @cindex input object files in linker scripts
3752 @cindex linker script input object files
3753 The @code{INPUT} command directs the linker to include the named files
3754 in the link, as though they were named on the command line.
3755
3756 For example, if you always want to include @file{subr.o} any time you do
3757 a link, but you can't be bothered to put it on every link command line,
3758 then you can put @samp{INPUT (subr.o)} in your linker script.
3759
3760 In fact, if you like, you can list all of your input files in the linker
3761 script, and then invoke the linker with nothing but a @samp{-T} option.
3762
3763 In case a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is configured, and the filename starts
3764 with the @samp{/} character, and the script being processed was
3765 located inside the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, the filename will be looked
3766 for in the @dfn{sysroot prefix}. The @dfn{sysroot prefix} can also be forced by specifying
3767 @code{=} as the first character in the filename path, or prefixing the
3768 filename path with @code{$SYSROOT}. See also the description of
3769 @samp{-L} in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
3770
3771 If a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is not used then the linker will try to open
3772 the file in the directory containing the linker script. If it is not
3773 found the linker will then search the current directory. If it is still
3774 not found the linker will search through the archive library search
3775 path.
3776
3777 If you use @samp{INPUT (-l@var{file})}, @command{ld} will transform the
3778 name to @code{lib@var{file}.a}, as with the command-line argument
3779 @samp{-l}.
3780
3781 When you use the @code{INPUT} command in an implicit linker script, the
3782 files will be included in the link at the point at which the linker
3783 script file is included. This can affect archive searching.
3784
3785 @item GROUP(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3786 @itemx GROUP(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3787 @kindex GROUP(@var{files})
3788 @cindex grouping input files
3789 The @code{GROUP} command is like @code{INPUT}, except that the named
3790 files should all be archives, and they are searched repeatedly until no
3791 new undefined references are created. See the description of @samp{-(}
3792 in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
3793
3794 @item AS_NEEDED(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3795 @itemx AS_NEEDED(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3796 @kindex AS_NEEDED(@var{files})
3797 This construct can appear only inside of the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP}
3798 commands, among other filenames. The files listed will be handled
3799 as if they appear directly in the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} commands,
3800 with the exception of ELF shared libraries, that will be added only
3801 when they are actually needed. This construct essentially enables
3802 @option{--as-needed} option for all the files listed inside of it
3803 and restores previous @option{--as-needed} resp. @option{--no-as-needed}
3804 setting afterwards.
3805
3806 @item OUTPUT(@var{filename})
3807 @kindex OUTPUT(@var{filename})
3808 @cindex output file name in linker script
3809 The @code{OUTPUT} command names the output file. Using
3810 @code{OUTPUT(@var{filename})} in the linker script is exactly like using
3811 @samp{-o @var{filename}} on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command
3812 Line Options}). If both are used, the command-line option takes
3813 precedence.
3814
3815 You can use the @code{OUTPUT} command to define a default name for the
3816 output file other than the usual default of @file{a.out}.
3817
3818 @item SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
3819 @kindex SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
3820 @cindex library search path in linker script
3821 @cindex archive search path in linker script
3822 @cindex search path in linker script
3823 The @code{SEARCH_DIR} command adds @var{path} to the list of paths where
3824 @command{ld} looks for archive libraries. Using
3825 @code{SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})} is exactly like using @samp{-L @var{path}}
3826 on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both
3827 are used, then the linker will search both paths. Paths specified using
3828 the command-line option are searched first.
3829
3830 @item STARTUP(@var{filename})
3831 @kindex STARTUP(@var{filename})
3832 @cindex first input file
3833 The @code{STARTUP} command is just like the @code{INPUT} command, except
3834 that @var{filename} will become the first input file to be linked, as
3835 though it were specified first on the command line. This may be useful
3836 when using a system in which the entry point is always the start of the
3837 first file.
3838 @end table
3839
3840 @ifclear SingleFormat
3841 @node Format Commands
3842 @subsection Commands Dealing with Object File Formats
3843 A couple of linker script commands deal with object file formats.
3844
3845 @table @code
3846 @item OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
3847 @itemx OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{default}, @var{big}, @var{little})
3848 @kindex OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
3849 @cindex output file format in linker script
3850 The @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command names the BFD format to use for the
3851 output file (@pxref{BFD}). Using @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})} is
3852 exactly like using @samp{--oformat @var{bfdname}} on the command line
3853 (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both are used, the command
3854 line option takes precedence.
3855
3856 You can use @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} with three arguments to use different
3857 formats based on the @samp{-EB} and @samp{-EL} command-line options.
3858 This permits the linker script to set the output format based on the
3859 desired endianness.
3860
3861 If neither @samp{-EB} nor @samp{-EL} are used, then the output format
3862 will be the first argument, @var{default}. If @samp{-EB} is used, the
3863 output format will be the second argument, @var{big}. If @samp{-EL} is
3864 used, the output format will be the third argument, @var{little}.
3865
3866 For example, the default linker script for the MIPS ELF target uses this
3867 command:
3868 @smallexample
3869 OUTPUT_FORMAT(elf32-bigmips, elf32-bigmips, elf32-littlemips)
3870 @end smallexample
3871 This says that the default format for the output file is
3872 @samp{elf32-bigmips}, but if the user uses the @samp{-EL} command-line
3873 option, the output file will be created in the @samp{elf32-littlemips}
3874 format.
3875
3876 @item TARGET(@var{bfdname})
3877 @kindex TARGET(@var{bfdname})
3878 @cindex input file format in linker script
3879 The @code{TARGET} command names the BFD format to use when reading input
3880 files. It affects subsequent @code{INPUT} and @code{GROUP} commands.
3881 This command is like using @samp{-b @var{bfdname}} on the command line
3882 (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If the @code{TARGET} command
3883 is used but @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} is not, then the last @code{TARGET}
3884 command is also used to set the format for the output file. @xref{BFD}.
3885 @end table
3886 @end ifclear
3887
3888 @node REGION_ALIAS
3889 @subsection Assign alias names to memory regions
3890 @kindex REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
3891 @cindex region alias
3892 @cindex region names
3893
3894 Alias names can be added to existing memory regions created with the
3895 @ref{MEMORY} command. Each name corresponds to at most one memory region.
3896
3897 @smallexample
3898 REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
3899 @end smallexample
3900
3901 The @code{REGION_ALIAS} function creates an alias name @var{alias} for the
3902 memory region @var{region}. This allows a flexible mapping of output sections
3903 to memory regions. An example follows.
3904
3905 Suppose we have an application for embedded systems which come with various
3906 memory storage devices. All have a general purpose, volatile memory @code{RAM}
3907 that allows code execution or data storage. Some may have a read-only,
3908 non-volatile memory @code{ROM} that allows code execution and read-only data
3909 access. The last variant is a read-only, non-volatile memory @code{ROM2} with
3910 read-only data access and no code execution capability. We have four output
3911 sections:
3912
3913 @itemize @bullet
3914 @item
3915 @code{.text} program code;
3916 @item
3917 @code{.rodata} read-only data;
3918 @item
3919 @code{.data} read-write initialized data;
3920 @item
3921 @code{.bss} read-write zero initialized data.
3922 @end itemize
3923
3924 The goal is to provide a linker command file that contains a system independent
3925 part defining the output sections and a system dependent part mapping the
3926 output sections to the memory regions available on the system. Our embedded
3927 systems come with three different memory setups @code{A}, @code{B} and
3928 @code{C}:
3929 @multitable @columnfractions .25 .25 .25 .25
3930 @item Section @tab Variant A @tab Variant B @tab Variant C
3931 @item .text @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM
3932 @item .rodata @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM2
3933 @item .data @tab RAM @tab RAM/ROM @tab RAM/ROM2
3934 @item .bss @tab RAM @tab RAM @tab RAM
3935 @end multitable
3936 The notation @code{RAM/ROM} or @code{RAM/ROM2} means that this section is
3937 loaded into region @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} respectively. Please note that
3938 the load address of the @code{.data} section starts in all three variants at
3939 the end of the @code{.rodata} section.
3940
3941 The base linker script that deals with the output sections follows. It
3942 includes the system dependent @code{linkcmds.memory} file that describes the
3943 memory layout:
3944 @smallexample
3945 INCLUDE linkcmds.memory
3946
3947 SECTIONS
3948 @{
3949 .text :
3950 @{
3951 *(.text)
3952 @} > REGION_TEXT
3953 .rodata :
3954 @{
3955 *(.rodata)
3956 rodata_end = .;
3957 @} > REGION_RODATA
3958 .data : AT (rodata_end)
3959 @{
3960 data_start = .;
3961 *(.data)
3962 @} > REGION_DATA
3963 data_size = SIZEOF(.data);
3964 data_load_start = LOADADDR(.data);
3965 .bss :
3966 @{
3967 *(.bss)
3968 @} > REGION_BSS
3969 @}
3970 @end smallexample
3971
3972 Now we need three different @code{linkcmds.memory} files to define memory
3973 regions and alias names. The content of @code{linkcmds.memory} for the three
3974 variants @code{A}, @code{B} and @code{C}:
3975 @table @code
3976 @item A
3977 Here everything goes into the @code{RAM}.
3978 @smallexample
3979 MEMORY
3980 @{
3981 RAM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 4M
3982 @}
3983
3984 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", RAM);
3985 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", RAM);
3986 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
3987 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
3988 @end smallexample
3989 @item B
3990 Program code and read-only data go into the @code{ROM}. Read-write data goes
3991 into the @code{RAM}. An image of the initialized data is loaded into the
3992 @code{ROM} and will be copied during system start into the @code{RAM}.
3993 @smallexample
3994 MEMORY
3995 @{
3996 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 3M
3997 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
3998 @}
3999
4000 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4001 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM);
4002 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4003 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4004 @end smallexample
4005 @item C
4006 Program code goes into the @code{ROM}. Read-only data goes into the
4007 @code{ROM2}. Read-write data goes into the @code{RAM}. An image of the
4008 initialized data is loaded into the @code{ROM2} and will be copied during
4009 system start into the @code{RAM}.
4010 @smallexample
4011 MEMORY
4012 @{
4013 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 2M
4014 ROM2 : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4015 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x20000000, LENGTH = 1M
4016 @}
4017
4018 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4019 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM2);
4020 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4021 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4022 @end smallexample
4023 @end table
4024
4025 It is possible to write a common system initialization routine to copy the
4026 @code{.data} section from @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} into the @code{RAM} if
4027 necessary:
4028 @smallexample
4029 #include <string.h>
4030
4031 extern char data_start [];
4032 extern char data_size [];
4033 extern char data_load_start [];
4034
4035 void copy_data(void)
4036 @{
4037 if (data_start != data_load_start)
4038 @{
4039 memcpy(data_start, data_load_start, (size_t) data_size);
4040 @}
4041 @}
4042 @end smallexample
4043
4044 @node Miscellaneous Commands
4045 @subsection Other Linker Script Commands
4046 There are a few other linker scripts commands.
4047
4048 @table @code
4049 @item ASSERT(@var{exp}, @var{message})
4050 @kindex ASSERT
4051 @cindex assertion in linker script
4052 Ensure that @var{exp} is non-zero. If it is zero, then exit the linker
4053 with an error code, and print @var{message}.
4054
4055 Note that assertions are checked before the final stages of linking
4056 take place. This means that expressions involving symbols PROVIDEd
4057 inside section definitions will fail if the user has not set values
4058 for those symbols. The only exception to this rule is PROVIDEd
4059 symbols that just reference dot. Thus an assertion like this:
4060
4061 @smallexample
4062 .stack :
4063 @{
4064 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4065 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4066 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4067 @}
4068 @end smallexample
4069
4070 will fail if @code{__stack_size} is not defined elsewhere. Symbols
4071 PROVIDEd outside of section definitions are evaluated earlier, so they
4072 can be used inside ASSERTions. Thus:
4073
4074 @smallexample
4075 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4076 .stack :
4077 @{
4078 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4079 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4080 @}
4081 @end smallexample
4082
4083 will work.
4084
4085 @item EXTERN(@var{symbol} @var{symbol} @dots{})
4086 @kindex EXTERN
4087 @cindex undefined symbol in linker script
4088 Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
4089 symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
4090 modules from standard libraries. You may list several @var{symbol}s for
4091 each @code{EXTERN}, and you may use @code{EXTERN} multiple times. This
4092 command has the same effect as the @samp{-u} command-line option.
4093
4094 @item FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4095 @kindex FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4096 @cindex common allocation in linker script
4097 This command has the same effect as the @samp{-d} command-line option:
4098 to make @command{ld} assign space to common symbols even if a relocatable
4099 output file is specified (@samp{-r}).
4100
4101 @item INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4102 @kindex INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4103 @cindex common allocation in linker script
4104 This command has the same effect as the @samp{--no-define-common}
4105 command-line option: to make @code{ld} omit the assignment of addresses
4106 to common symbols even for a non-relocatable output file.
4107
4108 @item FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4109 @kindex FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4110 @cindex group allocation in linker script
4111 @cindex section groups
4112 @cindex COMDAT
4113 This command has the same effect as the
4114 @samp{--force-group-allocation} command-line option: to make
4115 @command{ld} place section group members like normal input sections,
4116 and to delete the section groups even if a relocatable output file is
4117 specified (@samp{-r}).
4118
4119 @item INSERT [ AFTER | BEFORE ] @var{output_section}
4120 @kindex INSERT
4121 @cindex insert user script into default script
4122 This command is typically used in a script specified by @samp{-T} to
4123 augment the default @code{SECTIONS} with, for example, overlays. It
4124 inserts all prior linker script statements after (or before)
4125 @var{output_section}, and also causes @samp{-T} to not override the
4126 default linker script. The exact insertion point is as for orphan
4127 sections. @xref{Location Counter}. The insertion happens after the
4128 linker has mapped input sections to output sections. Prior to the
4129 insertion, since @samp{-T} scripts are parsed before the default
4130 linker script, statements in the @samp{-T} script occur before the
4131 default linker script statements in the internal linker representation
4132 of the script. In particular, input section assignments will be made
4133 to @samp{-T} output sections before those in the default script. Here
4134 is an example of how a @samp{-T} script using @code{INSERT} might look:
4135
4136 @smallexample
4137 SECTIONS
4138 @{
4139 OVERLAY :
4140 @{
4141 .ov1 @{ ov1*(.text) @}
4142 .ov2 @{ ov2*(.text) @}
4143 @}
4144 @}
4145 INSERT AFTER .text;
4146 @end smallexample
4147
4148 @item NOCROSSREFS(@var{section} @var{section} @dots{})
4149 @kindex NOCROSSREFS(@var{sections})
4150 @cindex cross references
4151 This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
4152 references among certain output sections.
4153
4154 In certain types of programs, particularly on embedded systems when
4155 using overlays, when one section is loaded into memory, another section
4156 will not be. Any direct references between the two sections would be
4157 errors. For example, it would be an error if code in one section called
4158 a function defined in the other section.
4159
4160 The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command takes a list of output section names. If
4161 @command{ld} detects any cross references between the sections, it reports
4162 an error and returns a non-zero exit status. Note that the
4163 @code{NOCROSSREFS} command uses output section names, not input section
4164 names.
4165
4166 @item NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsection} @dots{})
4167 @kindex NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsections})
4168 @cindex cross references
4169 This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
4170 references to one section from a list of other sections.
4171
4172 The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command is useful when ensuring that two or more
4173 output sections are entirely independent but there are situations where
4174 a one-way dependency is needed. For example, in a multi-core application
4175 there may be shared code that can be called from each core but for safety
4176 must never call back.
4177
4178 The @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command takes a list of output section names.
4179 The first section can not be referenced from any of the other sections.
4180 If @command{ld} detects any references to the first section from any of
4181 the other sections, it reports an error and returns a non-zero exit
4182 status. Note that the @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command uses output section
4183 names, not input section names.
4184
4185 @ifclear SingleFormat
4186 @item OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4187 @kindex OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4188 @cindex machine architecture
4189 @cindex architecture
4190 Specify a particular output machine architecture. The argument is one
4191 of the names used by the BFD library (@pxref{BFD}). You can see the
4192 architecture of an object file by using the @code{objdump} program with
4193 the @samp{-f} option.
4194 @end ifclear
4195
4196 @item LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4197 @kindex LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4198 This command may be used to modify @command{ld} behavior. If
4199 @var{string} is @code{"SANE_EXPR"} then absolute symbols and numbers
4200 in a script are simply treated as numbers everywhere.
4201 @xref{Expression Section}.
4202 @end table
4203
4204 @node Assignments
4205 @section Assigning Values to Symbols
4206 @cindex assignment in scripts
4207 @cindex symbol definition, scripts
4208 @cindex variables, defining
4209 You may assign a value to a symbol in a linker script. This will define
4210 the symbol and place it into the symbol table with a global scope.
4211
4212 @menu
4213 * Simple Assignments:: Simple Assignments
4214 * HIDDEN:: HIDDEN
4215 * PROVIDE:: PROVIDE
4216 * PROVIDE_HIDDEN:: PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4217 * Source Code Reference:: How to use a linker script defined symbol in source code
4218 @end menu
4219
4220 @node Simple Assignments
4221 @subsection Simple Assignments
4222
4223 You may assign to a symbol using any of the C assignment operators:
4224
4225 @table @code
4226 @item @var{symbol} = @var{expression} ;
4227 @itemx @var{symbol} += @var{expression} ;
4228 @itemx @var{symbol} -= @var{expression} ;
4229 @itemx @var{symbol} *= @var{expression} ;
4230 @itemx @var{symbol} /= @var{expression} ;
4231 @itemx @var{symbol} <<= @var{expression} ;
4232 @itemx @var{symbol} >>= @var{expression} ;
4233 @itemx @var{symbol} &= @var{expression} ;
4234 @itemx @var{symbol} |= @var{expression} ;
4235 @end table
4236
4237 The first case will define @var{symbol} to the value of
4238 @var{expression}. In the other cases, @var{symbol} must already be
4239 defined, and the value will be adjusted accordingly.
4240
4241 The special symbol name @samp{.} indicates the location counter. You
4242 may only use this within a @code{SECTIONS} command. @xref{Location Counter}.
4243
4244 The semicolon after @var{expression} is required.
4245
4246 Expressions are defined below; see @ref{Expressions}.
4247
4248 You may write symbol assignments as commands in their own right, or as
4249 statements within a @code{SECTIONS} command, or as part of an output
4250 section description in a @code{SECTIONS} command.
4251
4252 The section of the symbol will be set from the section of the
4253 expression; for more information, see @ref{Expression Section}.
4254
4255 Here is an example showing the three different places that symbol
4256 assignments may be used:
4257
4258 @smallexample
4259 floating_point = 0;
4260 SECTIONS
4261 @{
4262 .text :
4263 @{
4264 *(.text)
4265 _etext = .;
4266 @}
4267 _bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3;
4268 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4269 @}
4270 @end smallexample
4271 @noindent
4272 In this example, the symbol @samp{floating_point} will be defined as
4273 zero. The symbol @samp{_etext} will be defined as the address following
4274 the last @samp{.text} input section. The symbol @samp{_bdata} will be
4275 defined as the address following the @samp{.text} output section aligned
4276 upward to a 4 byte boundary.
4277
4278 @node HIDDEN
4279 @subsection HIDDEN
4280 @cindex HIDDEN
4281 For ELF targeted ports, define a symbol that will be hidden and won't be
4282 exported. The syntax is @code{HIDDEN(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4283
4284 Here is the example from @ref{Simple Assignments}, rewritten to use
4285 @code{HIDDEN}:
4286
4287 @smallexample
4288 HIDDEN(floating_point = 0);
4289 SECTIONS
4290 @{
4291 .text :
4292 @{
4293 *(.text)
4294 HIDDEN(_etext = .);
4295 @}
4296 HIDDEN(_bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3);
4297 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4298 @}
4299 @end smallexample
4300 @noindent
4301 In this case none of the three symbols will be visible outside this module.
4302
4303 @node PROVIDE
4304 @subsection PROVIDE
4305 @cindex PROVIDE
4306 In some cases, it is desirable for a linker script to define a symbol
4307 only if it is referenced and is not defined by any object included in
4308 the link. For example, traditional linkers defined the symbol
4309 @samp{etext}. However, ANSI C requires that the user be able to use
4310 @samp{etext} as a function name without encountering an error. The
4311 @code{PROVIDE} keyword may be used to define a symbol, such as
4312 @samp{etext}, only if it is referenced but not defined. The syntax is
4313 @code{PROVIDE(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4314
4315 Here is an example of using @code{PROVIDE} to define @samp{etext}:
4316 @smallexample
4317 SECTIONS
4318 @{
4319 .text :
4320 @{
4321 *(.text)
4322 _etext = .;
4323 PROVIDE(etext = .);
4324 @}
4325 @}
4326 @end smallexample
4327
4328 In this example, if the program defines @samp{_etext} (with a leading
4329 underscore), the linker will give a multiple definition error. If, on
4330 the other hand, the program defines @samp{etext} (with no leading
4331 underscore), the linker will silently use the definition in the program.
4332 If the program references @samp{etext} but does not define it, the
4333 linker will use the definition in the linker script.
4334
4335 Note - the @code{PROVIDE} directive considers a common symbol to be
4336 defined, even though such a symbol could be combined with the symbol
4337 that the @code{PROVIDE} would create. This is particularly important
4338 when considering constructor and destructor list symbols such as
4339 @samp{__CTOR_LIST__} as these are often defined as common symbols.
4340
4341 @node PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4342 @subsection PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4343 @cindex PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4344 Similar to @code{PROVIDE}. For ELF targeted ports, the symbol will be
4345 hidden and won't be exported.
4346
4347 @node Source Code Reference
4348 @subsection Source Code Reference
4349
4350 Accessing a linker script defined variable from source code is not
4351 intuitive. In particular a linker script symbol is not equivalent to
4352 a variable declaration in a high level language, it is instead a
4353 symbol that does not have a value.
4354
4355 Before going further, it is important to note that compilers often
4356 transform names in the source code into different names when they are
4357 stored in the symbol table. For example, Fortran compilers commonly
4358 prepend or append an underscore, and C++ performs extensive @samp{name
4359 mangling}. Therefore there might be a discrepancy between the name
4360 of a variable as it is used in source code and the name of the same
4361 variable as it is defined in a linker script. For example in C a
4362 linker script variable might be referred to as:
4363
4364 @smallexample
4365 extern int foo;
4366 @end smallexample
4367
4368 But in the linker script it might be defined as:
4369
4370 @smallexample
4371 _foo = 1000;
4372 @end smallexample
4373
4374 In the remaining examples however it is assumed that no name
4375 transformation has taken place.
4376
4377 When a symbol is declared in a high level language such as C, two
4378 things happen. The first is that the compiler reserves enough space
4379 in the program's memory to hold the @emph{value} of the symbol. The
4380 second is that the compiler creates an entry in the program's symbol
4381 table which holds the symbol's @emph{address}. ie the symbol table
4382 contains the address of the block of memory holding the symbol's
4383 value. So for example the following C declaration, at file scope:
4384
4385 @smallexample
4386 int foo = 1000;
4387 @end smallexample
4388
4389 creates an entry called @samp{foo} in the symbol table. This entry
4390 holds the address of an @samp{int} sized block of memory where the
4391 number 1000 is initially stored.
4392
4393 When a program references a symbol the compiler generates code that
4394 first accesses the symbol table to find the address of the symbol's
4395 memory block and then code to read the value from that memory block.
4396 So:
4397
4398 @smallexample
4399 foo = 1;
4400 @end smallexample
4401
4402 looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets the address
4403 associated with this symbol and then writes the value 1 into that
4404 address. Whereas:
4405
4406 @smallexample
4407 int * a = & foo;
4408 @end smallexample
4409
4410 looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets its address
4411 and then copies this address into the block of memory associated with
4412 the variable @samp{a}.
4413
4414 Linker scripts symbol declarations, by contrast, create an entry in
4415 the symbol table but do not assign any memory to them. Thus they are
4416 an address without a value. So for example the linker script definition:
4417
4418 @smallexample
4419 foo = 1000;
4420 @end smallexample
4421
4422 creates an entry in the symbol table called @samp{foo} which holds
4423 the address of memory location 1000, but nothing special is stored at
4424 address 1000. This means that you cannot access the @emph{value} of a
4425 linker script defined symbol - it has no value - all you can do is
4426 access the @emph{address} of a linker script defined symbol.
4427
4428 Hence when you are using a linker script defined symbol in source code
4429 you should always take the address of the symbol, and never attempt to
4430 use its value. For example suppose you want to copy the contents of a
4431 section of memory called .ROM into a section called .FLASH and the
4432 linker script contains these declarations:
4433
4434 @smallexample
4435 @group
4436 start_of_ROM = .ROM;
4437 end_of_ROM = .ROM + sizeof (.ROM);
4438 start_of_FLASH = .FLASH;
4439 @end group
4440 @end smallexample
4441
4442 Then the C source code to perform the copy would be:
4443
4444 @smallexample
4445 @group
4446 extern char start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM, start_of_FLASH;
4447
4448 memcpy (& start_of_FLASH, & start_of_ROM, & end_of_ROM - & start_of_ROM);
4449 @end group
4450 @end smallexample
4451
4452 Note the use of the @samp{&} operators. These are correct.
4453 Alternatively the symbols can be treated as the names of vectors or
4454 arrays and then the code will again work as expected:
4455
4456 @smallexample
4457 @group
4458 extern char start_of_ROM[], end_of_ROM[], start_of_FLASH[];
4459
4460 memcpy (start_of_FLASH, start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM - start_of_ROM);
4461 @end group
4462 @end smallexample
4463
4464 Note how using this method does not require the use of @samp{&}
4465 operators.
4466
4467 @node SECTIONS
4468 @section SECTIONS Command
4469 @kindex SECTIONS
4470 The @code{SECTIONS} command tells the linker how to map input sections
4471 into output sections, and how to place the output sections in memory.
4472
4473 The format of the @code{SECTIONS} command is:
4474 @smallexample
4475 SECTIONS
4476 @{
4477 @var{sections-command}
4478 @var{sections-command}
4479 @dots{}
4480 @}
4481 @end smallexample
4482
4483 Each @var{sections-command} may of be one of the following:
4484
4485 @itemize @bullet
4486 @item
4487 an @code{ENTRY} command (@pxref{Entry Point,,Entry command})
4488 @item
4489 a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4490 @item
4491 an output section description
4492 @item
4493 an overlay description
4494 @end itemize
4495
4496 The @code{ENTRY} command and symbol assignments are permitted inside the
4497 @code{SECTIONS} command for convenience in using the location counter in
4498 those commands. This can also make the linker script easier to
4499 understand because you can use those commands at meaningful points in
4500 the layout of the output file.
4501
4502 Output section descriptions and overlay descriptions are described
4503 below.
4504
4505 If you do not use a @code{SECTIONS} command in your linker script, the
4506 linker will place each input section into an identically named output
4507 section in the order that the sections are first encountered in the
4508 input files. If all input sections are present in the first file, for
4509 example, the order of sections in the output file will match the order
4510 in the first input file. The first section will be at address zero.
4511
4512 @menu
4513 * Output Section Description:: Output section description
4514 * Output Section Name:: Output section name
4515 * Output Section Address:: Output section address
4516 * Input Section:: Input section description
4517 * Output Section Data:: Output section data
4518 * Output Section Keywords:: Output section keywords
4519 * Output Section Discarding:: Output section discarding
4520 * Output Section Attributes:: Output section attributes
4521 * Overlay Description:: Overlay description
4522 @end menu
4523
4524 @node Output Section Description
4525 @subsection Output Section Description
4526 The full description of an output section looks like this:
4527 @smallexample
4528 @group
4529 @var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
4530 [AT(@var{lma})]
4531 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
4532 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
4533 [@var{constraint}]
4534 @{
4535 @var{output-section-command}
4536 @var{output-section-command}
4537 @dots{}
4538 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}] [,]
4539 @end group
4540 @end smallexample
4541
4542 Most output sections do not use most of the optional section attributes.
4543
4544 The whitespace around @var{section} is required, so that the section
4545 name is unambiguous. The colon and the curly braces are also required.
4546 The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fillexp} is used and
4547 the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
4548 The line breaks and other white space are optional.
4549
4550 Each @var{output-section-command} may be one of the following:
4551
4552 @itemize @bullet
4553 @item
4554 a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4555 @item
4556 an input section description (@pxref{Input Section})
4557 @item
4558 data values to include directly (@pxref{Output Section Data})
4559 @item
4560 a special output section keyword (@pxref{Output Section Keywords})
4561 @end itemize
4562
4563 @node Output Section Name
4564 @subsection Output Section Name
4565 @cindex name, section
4566 @cindex section name
4567 The name of the output section is @var{section}. @var{section} must
4568 meet the constraints of your output format. In formats which only
4569 support a limited number of sections, such as @code{a.out}, the name
4570 must be one of the names supported by the format (@code{a.out}, for
4571 example, allows only @samp{.text}, @samp{.data} or @samp{.bss}). If the
4572 output format supports any number of sections, but with numbers and not
4573 names (as is the case for Oasys), the name should be supplied as a
4574 quoted numeric string. A section name may consist of any sequence of
4575 characters, but a name which contains any unusual characters such as
4576 commas must be quoted.
4577
4578 The output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} is special; @ref{Output Section
4579 Discarding}.
4580
4581 @node Output Section Address
4582 @subsection Output Section Address
4583 @cindex address, section
4584 @cindex section address
4585 The @var{address} is an expression for the VMA (the virtual memory
4586 address) of the output section. This address is optional, but if it
4587 is provided then the output address will be set exactly as specified.
4588
4589 If the output address is not specified then one will be chosen for the
4590 section, based on the heuristic below. This address will be adjusted
4591 to fit the alignment requirement of the output section. The
4592 alignment requirement is the strictest alignment of any input section
4593 contained within the output section.
4594
4595 The output section address heuristic is as follows:
4596
4597 @itemize @bullet
4598 @item
4599 If an output memory @var{region} is set for the section then it
4600 is added to this region and its address will be the next free address
4601 in that region.
4602
4603 @item
4604 If the MEMORY command has been used to create a list of memory
4605 regions then the first region which has attributes compatible with the
4606 section is selected to contain it. The section's output address will
4607 be the next free address in that region; @ref{MEMORY}.
4608
4609 @item
4610 If no memory regions were specified, or none match the section then
4611 the output address will be based on the current value of the location
4612 counter.
4613 @end itemize
4614
4615 @noindent
4616 For example:
4617
4618 @smallexample
4619 .text . : @{ *(.text) @}
4620 @end smallexample
4621
4622 @noindent
4623 and
4624
4625 @smallexample
4626 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
4627 @end smallexample
4628
4629 @noindent
4630 are subtly different. The first will set the address of the
4631 @samp{.text} output section to the current value of the location
4632 counter. The second will set it to the current value of the location
4633 counter aligned to the strictest alignment of any of the @samp{.text}
4634 input sections.
4635
4636 The @var{address} may be an arbitrary expression; @ref{Expressions}.
4637 For example, if you want to align the section on a 0x10 byte boundary,
4638 so that the lowest four bits of the section address are zero, you could
4639 do something like this:
4640 @smallexample
4641 .text ALIGN(0x10) : @{ *(.text) @}
4642 @end smallexample
4643 @noindent
4644 This works because @code{ALIGN} returns the current location counter
4645 aligned upward to the specified value.
4646
4647 Specifying @var{address} for a section will change the value of the
4648 location counter, provided that the section is non-empty. (Empty
4649 sections are ignored).
4650
4651 @node Input Section
4652 @subsection Input Section Description
4653 @cindex input sections
4654 @cindex mapping input sections to output sections
4655 The most common output section command is an input section description.
4656
4657 The input section description is the most basic linker script operation.
4658 You use output sections to tell the linker how to lay out your program
4659 in memory. You use input section descriptions to tell the linker how to
4660 map the input files into your memory layout.
4661
4662 @menu
4663 * Input Section Basics:: Input section basics
4664 * Input Section Wildcards:: Input section wildcard patterns
4665 * Input Section Common:: Input section for common symbols
4666 * Input Section Keep:: Input section and garbage collection
4667 * Input Section Example:: Input section example
4668 @end menu
4669
4670 @node Input Section Basics
4671 @subsubsection Input Section Basics
4672 @cindex input section basics
4673 An input section description consists of a file name optionally followed
4674 by a list of section names in parentheses.
4675
4676 The file name and the section name may be wildcard patterns, which we
4677 describe further below (@pxref{Input Section Wildcards}).
4678
4679 The most common input section description is to include all input
4680 sections with a particular name in the output section. For example, to
4681 include all input @samp{.text} sections, you would write:
4682 @smallexample
4683 *(.text)
4684 @end smallexample
4685 @noindent
4686 Here the @samp{*} is a wildcard which matches any file name. To exclude a list
4687 @cindex EXCLUDE_FILE
4688 of files from matching the file name wildcard, EXCLUDE_FILE may be used to
4689 match all files except the ones specified in the EXCLUDE_FILE list. For
4690 example:
4691 @smallexample
4692 EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) *(.ctors)
4693 @end smallexample
4694 @noindent
4695 will cause all .ctors sections from all files except @file{crtend.o}
4696 and @file{otherfile.o} to be included. The EXCLUDE_FILE can also be
4697 placed inside the section list, for example:
4698 @smallexample
4699 *(EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) .ctors)
4700 @end smallexample
4701 @noindent
4702 The result of this is identically to the previous example. Supporting
4703 two syntaxes for EXCLUDE_FILE is useful if the section list contains
4704 more than one section, as described below.
4705
4706 There are two ways to include more than one section:
4707 @smallexample
4708 *(.text .rdata)
4709 *(.text) *(.rdata)
4710 @end smallexample
4711 @noindent
4712 The difference between these is the order in which the @samp{.text} and
4713 @samp{.rdata} input sections will appear in the output section. In the
4714 first example, they will be intermingled, appearing in the same order as
4715 they are found in the linker input. In the second example, all
4716 @samp{.text} input sections will appear first, followed by all
4717 @samp{.rdata} input sections.
4718
4719 When using EXCLUDE_FILE with more than one section, if the exclusion
4720 is within the section list then the exclusion only applies to the
4721 immediately following section, for example:
4722 @smallexample
4723 *(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text .rdata)
4724 @end smallexample
4725 @noindent
4726 will cause all @samp{.text} sections from all files except
4727 @file{somefile.o} to be included, while all @samp{.rdata} sections
4728 from all files, including @file{somefile.o}, will be included. To
4729 exclude the @samp{.rdata} sections from @file{somefile.o} the example
4730 could be modified to:
4731 @smallexample
4732 *(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .rdata)
4733 @end smallexample
4734 @noindent
4735 Alternatively, placing the EXCLUDE_FILE outside of the section list,
4736 before the input file selection, will cause the exclusion to apply for
4737 all sections. Thus the previous example can be rewritten as:
4738 @smallexample
4739 EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) *(.text .rdata)
4740 @end smallexample
4741
4742 You can specify a file name to include sections from a particular file.
4743 You would do this if one or more of your files contain special data that
4744 needs to be at a particular location in memory. For example:
4745 @smallexample
4746 data.o(.data)
4747 @end smallexample
4748
4749 To refine the sections that are included based on the section flags
4750 of an input section, INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS may be used.
4751
4752 Here is a simple example for using Section header flags for ELF sections:
4753
4754 @smallexample
4755 @group
4756 SECTIONS @{
4757 .text : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (SHF_MERGE & SHF_STRINGS) *(.text) @}
4758 .text2 : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (!SHF_WRITE) *(.text) @}
4759 @}
4760 @end group
4761 @end smallexample
4762
4763 In this example, the output section @samp{.text} will be comprised of any
4764 input section matching the name *(.text) whose section header flags
4765 @code{SHF_MERGE} and @code{SHF_STRINGS} are set. The output section
4766 @samp{.text2} will be comprised of any input section matching the name *(.text)
4767 whose section header flag @code{SHF_WRITE} is clear.
4768
4769 You can also specify files within archives by writing a pattern
4770 matching the archive, a colon, then the pattern matching the file,
4771 with no whitespace around the colon.
4772
4773 @table @samp
4774 @item archive:file
4775 matches file within archive
4776 @item archive:
4777 matches the whole archive
4778 @item :file
4779 matches file but not one in an archive
4780 @end table
4781
4782 Either one or both of @samp{archive} and @samp{file} can contain shell
4783 wildcards. On DOS based file systems, the linker will assume that a
4784 single letter followed by a colon is a drive specifier, so
4785 @samp{c:myfile.o} is a simple file specification, not @samp{myfile.o}
4786 within an archive called @samp{c}. @samp{archive:file} filespecs may
4787 also be used within an @code{EXCLUDE_FILE} list, but may not appear in
4788 other linker script contexts. For instance, you cannot extract a file
4789 from an archive by using @samp{archive:file} in an @code{INPUT}
4790 command.
4791
4792 If you use a file name without a list of sections, then all sections in
4793 the input file will be included in the output section. This is not
4794 commonly done, but it may by useful on occasion. For example:
4795 @smallexample
4796 data.o
4797 @end smallexample
4798
4799 When you use a file name which is not an @samp{archive:file} specifier
4800 and does not contain any wild card
4801 characters, the linker will first see if you also specified the file
4802 name on the linker command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. If you
4803 did not, the linker will attempt to open the file as an input file, as
4804 though it appeared on the command line. Note that this differs from an
4805 @code{INPUT} command, because the linker will not search for the file in
4806 the archive search path.
4807
4808 @node Input Section Wildcards
4809 @subsubsection Input Section Wildcard Patterns
4810 @cindex input section wildcards
4811 @cindex wildcard file name patterns
4812 @cindex file name wildcard patterns
4813 @cindex section name wildcard patterns
4814 In an input section description, either the file name or the section
4815 name or both may be wildcard patterns.
4816
4817 The file name of @samp{*} seen in many examples is a simple wildcard
4818 pattern for the file name.
4819
4820 The wildcard patterns are like those used by the Unix shell.
4821
4822 @table @samp
4823 @item *
4824 matches any number of characters
4825 @item ?
4826 matches any single character
4827 @item [@var{chars}]
4828 matches a single instance of any of the @var{chars}; the @samp{-}
4829 character may be used to specify a range of characters, as in
4830 @samp{[a-z]} to match any lower case letter
4831 @item \
4832 quotes the following character
4833 @end table
4834
4835 When a file name is matched with a wildcard, the wildcard characters
4836 will not match a @samp{/} character (used to separate directory names on
4837 Unix). A pattern consisting of a single @samp{*} character is an
4838 exception; it will always match any file name, whether it contains a
4839 @samp{/} or not. In a section name, the wildcard characters will match
4840 a @samp{/} character.
4841
4842 File name wildcard patterns only match files which are explicitly
4843 specified on the command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. The linker
4844 does not search directories to expand wildcards.
4845
4846 If a file name matches more than one wildcard pattern, or if a file name
4847 appears explicitly and is also matched by a wildcard pattern, the linker
4848 will use the first match in the linker script. For example, this
4849 sequence of input section descriptions is probably in error, because the
4850 @file{data.o} rule will not be used:
4851 @smallexample
4852 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4853 .data1 : @{ data.o(.data) @}
4854 @end smallexample
4855
4856 @cindex SORT_BY_NAME
4857 Normally, the linker will place files and sections matched by wildcards
4858 in the order in which they are seen during the link. You can change
4859 this by using the @code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword, which appears before a wildcard
4860 pattern in parentheses (e.g., @code{SORT_BY_NAME(.text*)}). When the
4861 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword is used, the linker will sort the files or sections
4862 into ascending order by name before placing them in the output file.
4863
4864 @cindex SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT
4865 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} is similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
4866 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} will sort sections into descending order of
4867 alignment before placing them in the output file. Placing larger
4868 alignments before smaller alignments can reduce the amount of padding
4869 needed.
4870
4871 @cindex SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY
4872 @code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} is also similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
4873 @code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} will sort sections into ascending
4874 numerical order of the GCC init_priority attribute encoded in the
4875 section name before placing them in the output file. In
4876 @code{.init_array.NNNNN} and @code{.fini_array.NNNNN}, @code{NNNNN} is
4877 the init_priority. In @code{.ctors.NNNNN} and @code{.dtors.NNNNN},
4878 @code{NNNNN} is 65535 minus the init_priority.
4879
4880 @cindex SORT
4881 @code{SORT} is an alias for @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
4882
4883 When there are nested section sorting commands in linker script, there
4884 can be at most 1 level of nesting for section sorting commands.
4885
4886 @enumerate
4887 @item
4888 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
4889 It will sort the input sections by name first, then by alignment if two
4890 sections have the same name.
4891 @item
4892 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
4893 It will sort the input sections by alignment first, then by name if two
4894 sections have the same alignment.
4895 @item
4896 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)) is
4897 treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern).
4898 @item
4899 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern))
4900 is treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern).
4901 @item
4902 All other nested section sorting commands are invalid.
4903 @end enumerate
4904
4905 When both command-line section sorting option and linker script
4906 section sorting command are used, section sorting command always
4907 takes precedence over the command-line option.
4908
4909 If the section sorting command in linker script isn't nested, the
4910 command-line option will make the section sorting command to be
4911 treated as nested sorting command.
4912
4913 @enumerate
4914 @item
4915 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern ) with
4916 @option{--sort-sections alignment} is equivalent to
4917 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
4918 @item
4919 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern) with
4920 @option{--sort-section name} is equivalent to
4921 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
4922 @end enumerate
4923
4924 If the section sorting command in linker script is nested, the
4925 command-line option will be ignored.
4926
4927 @cindex SORT_NONE
4928 @code{SORT_NONE} disables section sorting by ignoring the command-line
4929 section sorting option.
4930
4931 If you ever get confused about where input sections are going, use the
4932 @samp{-M} linker option to generate a map file. The map file shows
4933 precisely how input sections are mapped to output sections.
4934
4935 This example shows how wildcard patterns might be used to partition
4936 files. This linker script directs the linker to place all @samp{.text}
4937 sections in @samp{.text} and all @samp{.bss} sections in @samp{.bss}.
4938 The linker will place the @samp{.data} section from all files beginning
4939 with an upper case character in @samp{.DATA}; for all other files, the
4940 linker will place the @samp{.data} section in @samp{.data}.
4941 @smallexample
4942 @group
4943 SECTIONS @{
4944 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
4945 .DATA : @{ [A-Z]*(.data) @}
4946 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4947 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
4948 @}
4949 @end group
4950 @end smallexample
4951
4952 @node Input Section Common
4953 @subsubsection Input Section for Common Symbols
4954 @cindex common symbol placement
4955 @cindex uninitialized data placement
4956 A special notation is needed for common symbols, because in many object
4957 file formats common symbols do not have a particular input section. The
4958 linker treats common symbols as though they are in an input section
4959 named @samp{COMMON}.
4960
4961 You may use file names with the @samp{COMMON} section just as with any
4962 other input sections. You can use this to place common symbols from a
4963 particular input file in one section while common symbols from other
4964 input files are placed in another section.
4965
4966 In most cases, common symbols in input files will be placed in the
4967 @samp{.bss} section in the output file. For example:
4968 @smallexample
4969 .bss @{ *(.bss) *(COMMON) @}
4970 @end smallexample
4971
4972 @cindex scommon section
4973 @cindex small common symbols
4974 Some object file formats have more than one type of common symbol. For
4975 example, the MIPS ELF object file format distinguishes standard common
4976 symbols and small common symbols. In this case, the linker will use a
4977 different special section name for other types of common symbols. In
4978 the case of MIPS ELF, the linker uses @samp{COMMON} for standard common
4979 symbols and @samp{.scommon} for small common symbols. This permits you
4980 to map the different types of common symbols into memory at different
4981 locations.
4982
4983 @cindex [COMMON]
4984 You will sometimes see @samp{[COMMON]} in old linker scripts. This
4985 notation is now considered obsolete. It is equivalent to
4986 @samp{*(COMMON)}.
4987
4988 @node Input Section Keep
4989 @subsubsection Input Section and Garbage Collection
4990 @cindex KEEP
4991 @cindex garbage collection
4992 When link-time garbage collection is in use (@samp{--gc-sections}),
4993 it is often useful to mark sections that should not be eliminated.
4994 This is accomplished by surrounding an input section's wildcard entry
4995 with @code{KEEP()}, as in @code{KEEP(*(.init))} or
4996 @code{KEEP(SORT_BY_NAME(*)(.ctors))}.
4997
4998 @node Input Section Example
4999 @subsubsection Input Section Example
5000 The following example is a complete linker script. It tells the linker
5001 to read all of the sections from file @file{all.o} and place them at the
5002 start of output section @samp{outputa} which starts at location
5003 @samp{0x10000}. All of section @samp{.input1} from file @file{foo.o}
5004 follows immediately, in the same output section. All of section
5005 @samp{.input2} from @file{foo.o} goes into output section
5006 @samp{outputb}, followed by section @samp{.input1} from @file{foo1.o}.
5007 All of the remaining @samp{.input1} and @samp{.input2} sections from any
5008 files are written to output section @samp{outputc}.
5009
5010 @smallexample
5011 @group
5012 SECTIONS @{
5013 outputa 0x10000 :
5014 @{
5015 all.o
5016 foo.o (.input1)
5017 @}
5018 @end group
5019 @group
5020 outputb :
5021 @{
5022 foo.o (.input2)
5023 foo1.o (.input1)
5024 @}
5025 @end group
5026 @group
5027 outputc :
5028 @{
5029 *(.input1)
5030 *(.input2)
5031 @}
5032 @}
5033 @end group
5034 @end smallexample
5035
5036 If an output section's name is the same as the input section's name
5037 and is representable as a C identifier, then the linker will
5038 automatically @pxref{PROVIDE} two symbols: __start_SECNAME and
5039 __stop_SECNAME, where SECNAME is the name of the section. These
5040 indicate the start address and end address of the output section
5041 respectively. Note: most section names are not representable as
5042 C identifiers because they contain a @samp{.} character.
5043
5044 @node Output Section Data
5045 @subsection Output Section Data
5046 @cindex data
5047 @cindex section data
5048 @cindex output section data
5049 @kindex BYTE(@var{expression})
5050 @kindex SHORT(@var{expression})
5051 @kindex LONG(@var{expression})
5052 @kindex QUAD(@var{expression})
5053 @kindex SQUAD(@var{expression})
5054 You can include explicit bytes of data in an output section by using
5055 @code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, @code{QUAD}, or @code{SQUAD} as
5056 an output section command. Each keyword is followed by an expression in
5057 parentheses providing the value to store (@pxref{Expressions}). The
5058 value of the expression is stored at the current value of the location
5059 counter.
5060
5061 The @code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, and @code{QUAD} commands
5062 store one, two, four, and eight bytes (respectively). After storing the
5063 bytes, the location counter is incremented by the number of bytes
5064 stored.
5065
5066 For example, this will store the byte 1 followed by the four byte value
5067 of the symbol @samp{addr}:
5068 @smallexample
5069 BYTE(1)
5070 LONG(addr)
5071 @end smallexample
5072
5073 When using a 64 bit host or target, @code{QUAD} and @code{SQUAD} are the
5074 same; they both store an 8 byte, or 64 bit, value. When both host and
5075 target are 32 bits, an expression is computed as 32 bits. In this case
5076 @code{QUAD} stores a 32 bit value zero extended to 64 bits, and
5077 @code{SQUAD} stores a 32 bit value sign extended to 64 bits.
5078
5079 If the object file format of the output file has an explicit endianness,
5080 which is the normal case, the value will be stored in that endianness.
5081 When the object file format does not have an explicit endianness, as is
5082 true of, for example, S-records, the value will be stored in the
5083 endianness of the first input object file.
5084
5085 Note---these commands only work inside a section description and not
5086 between them, so the following will produce an error from the linker:
5087 @smallexample
5088 SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) @}@ LONG(1) .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5089 @end smallexample
5090 whereas this will work:
5091 @smallexample
5092 SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) ; LONG(1) @}@ .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5093 @end smallexample
5094
5095 @kindex FILL(@var{expression})
5096 @cindex holes, filling
5097 @cindex unspecified memory
5098 You may use the @code{FILL} command to set the fill pattern for the
5099 current section. It is followed by an expression in parentheses. Any
5100 otherwise unspecified regions of memory within the section (for example,
5101 gaps left due to the required alignment of input sections) are filled
5102 with the value of the expression, repeated as
5103 necessary. A @code{FILL} statement covers memory locations after the
5104 point at which it occurs in the section definition; by including more
5105 than one @code{FILL} statement, you can have different fill patterns in
5106 different parts of an output section.
5107
5108 This example shows how to fill unspecified regions of memory with the
5109 value @samp{0x90}:
5110 @smallexample
5111 FILL(0x90909090)
5112 @end smallexample
5113
5114 The @code{FILL} command is similar to the @samp{=@var{fillexp}} output
5115 section attribute, but it only affects the
5116 part of the section following the @code{FILL} command, rather than the
5117 entire section. If both are used, the @code{FILL} command takes
5118 precedence. @xref{Output Section Fill}, for details on the fill
5119 expression.
5120
5121 @node Output Section Keywords
5122 @subsection Output Section Keywords
5123 There are a couple of keywords which can appear as output section
5124 commands.
5125
5126 @table @code
5127 @kindex CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5128 @cindex input filename symbols
5129 @cindex filename symbols
5130 @item CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5131 The command tells the linker to create a symbol for each input file.
5132 The name of each symbol will be the name of the corresponding input
5133 file. The section of each symbol will be the output section in which
5134 the @code{CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS} command appears.
5135
5136 This is conventional for the a.out object file format. It is not
5137 normally used for any other object file format.
5138
5139 @kindex CONSTRUCTORS
5140 @cindex C++ constructors, arranging in link
5141 @cindex constructors, arranging in link
5142 @item CONSTRUCTORS
5143 When linking using the a.out object file format, the linker uses an
5144 unusual set construct to support C++ global constructors and
5145 destructors. When linking object file formats which do not support
5146 arbitrary sections, such as ECOFF and XCOFF, the linker will
5147 automatically recognize C++ global constructors and destructors by name.
5148 For these object file formats, the @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command tells the
5149 linker to place constructor information in the output section where the
5150 @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command appears. The @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command is
5151 ignored for other object file formats.
5152
5153 The symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_LIST__}} marks the start of the global
5154 constructors, and the symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_END__}} marks the end.
5155 Similarly, @w{@code{__DTOR_LIST__}} and @w{@code{__DTOR_END__}} mark
5156 the start and end of the global destructors. The
5157 first word in the list is the number of entries, followed by the address
5158 of each constructor or destructor, followed by a zero word. The
5159 compiler must arrange to actually run the code. For these object file
5160 formats @sc{gnu} C++ normally calls constructors from a subroutine
5161 @code{__main}; a call to @code{__main} is automatically inserted into
5162 the startup code for @code{main}. @sc{gnu} C++ normally runs
5163 destructors either by using @code{atexit}, or directly from the function
5164 @code{exit}.
5165
5166 For object file formats such as @code{COFF} or @code{ELF} which support
5167 arbitrary section names, @sc{gnu} C++ will normally arrange to put the
5168 addresses of global constructors and destructors into the @code{.ctors}
5169 and @code{.dtors} sections. Placing the following sequence into your
5170 linker script will build the sort of table which the @sc{gnu} C++
5171 runtime code expects to see.
5172
5173 @smallexample
5174 __CTOR_LIST__ = .;
5175 LONG((__CTOR_END__ - __CTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5176 *(.ctors)
5177 LONG(0)
5178 __CTOR_END__ = .;
5179 __DTOR_LIST__ = .;
5180 LONG((__DTOR_END__ - __DTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5181 *(.dtors)
5182 LONG(0)
5183 __DTOR_END__ = .;
5184 @end smallexample
5185
5186 If you are using the @sc{gnu} C++ support for initialization priority,
5187 which provides some control over the order in which global constructors
5188 are run, you must sort the constructors at link time to ensure that they
5189 are executed in the correct order. When using the @code{CONSTRUCTORS}
5190 command, use @samp{SORT_BY_NAME(CONSTRUCTORS)} instead. When using the
5191 @code{.ctors} and @code{.dtors} sections, use @samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.ctors))} and
5192 @samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.dtors))} instead of just @samp{*(.ctors)} and
5193 @samp{*(.dtors)}.
5194
5195 Normally the compiler and linker will handle these issues automatically,
5196 and you will not need to concern yourself with them. However, you may
5197 need to consider this if you are using C++ and writing your own linker
5198 scripts.
5199
5200 @end table
5201
5202 @node Output Section Discarding
5203 @subsection Output Section Discarding
5204 @cindex discarding sections
5205 @cindex sections, discarding
5206 @cindex removing sections
5207 The linker will not normally create output sections with no contents.
5208 This is for convenience when referring to input sections that may or
5209 may not be present in any of the input files. For example:
5210 @smallexample
5211 .foo : @{ *(.foo) @}
5212 @end smallexample
5213 @noindent
5214 will only create a @samp{.foo} section in the output file if there is a
5215 @samp{.foo} section in at least one input file, and if the input
5216 sections are not all empty. Other link script directives that allocate
5217 space in an output section will also create the output section. So
5218 too will assignments to dot even if the assignment does not create
5219 space, except for @samp{. = 0}, @samp{. = . + 0}, @samp{. = sym},
5220 @samp{. = . + sym} and @samp{. = ALIGN (. != 0, expr, 1)} when
5221 @samp{sym} is an absolute symbol of value 0 defined in the script.
5222 This allows you to force output of an empty section with @samp{. = .}.
5223
5224 The linker will ignore address assignments (@pxref{Output Section Address})
5225 on discarded output sections, except when the linker script defines
5226 symbols in the output section. In that case the linker will obey
5227 the address assignments, possibly advancing dot even though the
5228 section is discarded.
5229
5230 @cindex /DISCARD/
5231 The special output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} may be used to discard
5232 input sections. Any input sections which are assigned to an output
5233 section named @samp{/DISCARD/} are not included in the output file.
5234
5235 Note, sections that match the @samp{/DISCARD/} output section will be
5236 discarded even if they are in an ELF section group which has other
5237 members which are not being discarded. This is deliberate.
5238 Discarding takes precedence over grouping.
5239
5240 @node Output Section Attributes
5241 @subsection Output Section Attributes
5242 @cindex output section attributes
5243 We showed above that the full description of an output section looked
5244 like this:
5245
5246 @smallexample
5247 @group
5248 @var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
5249 [AT(@var{lma})]
5250 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
5251 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
5252 [@var{constraint}]
5253 @{
5254 @var{output-section-command}
5255 @var{output-section-command}
5256 @dots{}
5257 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}]
5258 @end group
5259 @end smallexample
5260
5261 We've already described @var{section}, @var{address}, and
5262 @var{output-section-command}. In this section we will describe the
5263 remaining section attributes.
5264
5265 @menu
5266 * Output Section Type:: Output section type
5267 * Output Section LMA:: Output section LMA
5268 * Forced Output Alignment:: Forced Output Alignment
5269 * Forced Input Alignment:: Forced Input Alignment
5270 * Output Section Constraint:: Output section constraint
5271 * Output Section Region:: Output section region
5272 * Output Section Phdr:: Output section phdr
5273 * Output Section Fill:: Output section fill
5274 @end menu
5275
5276 @node Output Section Type
5277 @subsubsection Output Section Type
5278 Each output section may have a type. The type is a keyword in
5279 parentheses. The following types are defined:
5280
5281 @table @code
5282 @item NOLOAD
5283 The section should be marked as not loadable, so that it will not be
5284 loaded into memory when the program is run.
5285 @item DSECT
5286 @itemx COPY
5287 @itemx INFO
5288 @itemx OVERLAY
5289 These type names are supported for backward compatibility, and are
5290 rarely used. They all have the same effect: the section should be
5291 marked as not allocatable, so that no memory is allocated for the
5292 section when the program is run.
5293 @end table
5294
5295 @kindex NOLOAD
5296 @cindex prevent unnecessary loading
5297 @cindex loading, preventing
5298 The linker normally sets the attributes of an output section based on
5299 the input sections which map into it. You can override this by using
5300 the section type. For example, in the script sample below, the
5301 @samp{ROM} section is addressed at memory location @samp{0} and does not
5302 need to be loaded when the program is run.
5303 @smallexample
5304 @group
5305 SECTIONS @{
5306 ROM 0 (NOLOAD) : @{ @dots{} @}
5307 @dots{}
5308 @}
5309 @end group
5310 @end smallexample
5311
5312 @node Output Section LMA
5313 @subsubsection Output Section LMA
5314 @kindex AT>@var{lma_region}
5315 @kindex AT(@var{lma})
5316 @cindex load address
5317 @cindex section load address
5318 Every section has a virtual address (VMA) and a load address (LMA); see
5319 @ref{Basic Script Concepts}. The virtual address is specified by the
5320 @pxref{Output Section Address} described earlier. The load address is
5321 specified by the @code{AT} or @code{AT>} keywords. Specifying a load
5322 address is optional.
5323
5324 The @code{AT} keyword takes an expression as an argument. This
5325 specifies the exact load address of the section. The @code{AT>} keyword
5326 takes the name of a memory region as an argument. @xref{MEMORY}. The
5327 load address of the section is set to the next free address in the
5328 region, aligned to the section's alignment requirements.
5329
5330 If neither @code{AT} nor @code{AT>} is specified for an allocatable
5331 section, the linker will use the following heuristic to determine the
5332 load address:
5333
5334 @itemize @bullet
5335 @item
5336 If the section has a specific VMA address, then this is used as
5337 the LMA address as well.
5338
5339 @item
5340 If the section is not allocatable then its LMA is set to its VMA.
5341
5342 @item
5343 Otherwise if a memory region can be found that is compatible
5344 with the current section, and this region contains at least one
5345 section, then the LMA is set so the difference between the
5346 VMA and LMA is the same as the difference between the VMA and LMA of
5347 the last section in the located region.
5348
5349 @item
5350 If no memory regions have been declared then a default region
5351 that covers the entire address space is used in the previous step.
5352
5353 @item
5354 If no suitable region could be found, or there was no previous
5355 section then the LMA is set equal to the VMA.
5356 @end itemize
5357
5358 @cindex ROM initialized data
5359 @cindex initialized data in ROM
5360 This feature is designed to make it easy to build a ROM image. For
5361 example, the following linker script creates three output sections: one
5362 called @samp{.text}, which starts at @code{0x1000}, one called
5363 @samp{.mdata}, which is loaded at the end of the @samp{.text} section
5364 even though its VMA is @code{0x2000}, and one called @samp{.bss} to hold
5365 uninitialized data at address @code{0x3000}. The symbol @code{_data} is
5366 defined with the value @code{0x2000}, which shows that the location
5367 counter holds the VMA value, not the LMA value.
5368
5369 @smallexample
5370 @group
5371 SECTIONS
5372 @{
5373 .text 0x1000 : @{ *(.text) _etext = . ; @}
5374 .mdata 0x2000 :
5375 AT ( ADDR (.text) + SIZEOF (.text) )
5376 @{ _data = . ; *(.data); _edata = . ; @}
5377 .bss 0x3000 :
5378 @{ _bstart = . ; *(.bss) *(COMMON) ; _bend = . ;@}
5379 @}
5380 @end group
5381 @end smallexample
5382
5383 The run-time initialization code for use with a program generated with
5384 this linker script would include something like the following, to copy
5385 the initialized data from the ROM image to its runtime address. Notice
5386 how this code takes advantage of the symbols defined by the linker
5387 script.
5388
5389 @smallexample
5390 @group
5391 extern char _etext, _data, _edata, _bstart, _bend;
5392 char *src = &_etext;
5393 char *dst = &_data;
5394
5395 /* ROM has data at end of text; copy it. */
5396 while (dst < &_edata)
5397 *dst++ = *src++;
5398
5399 /* Zero bss. */
5400 for (dst = &_bstart; dst< &_bend; dst++)
5401 *dst = 0;
5402 @end group
5403 @end smallexample
5404
5405 @node Forced Output Alignment
5406 @subsubsection Forced Output Alignment
5407 @kindex ALIGN(@var{section_align})
5408 @cindex forcing output section alignment
5409 @cindex output section alignment
5410 You can increase an output section's alignment by using ALIGN. As an
5411 alternative you can enforce that the difference between the VMA and LMA remains
5412 intact throughout this output section with the ALIGN_WITH_INPUT attribute.
5413
5414 @node Forced Input Alignment
5415 @subsubsection Forced Input Alignment
5416 @kindex SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})
5417 @cindex forcing input section alignment
5418 @cindex input section alignment
5419 You can force input section alignment within an output section by using
5420 SUBALIGN. The value specified overrides any alignment given by input
5421 sections, whether larger or smaller.
5422
5423 @node Output Section Constraint
5424 @subsubsection Output Section Constraint
5425 @kindex ONLY_IF_RO
5426 @kindex ONLY_IF_RW
5427 @cindex constraints on output sections
5428 You can specify that an output section should only be created if all
5429 of its input sections are read-only or all of its input sections are
5430 read-write by using the keyword @code{ONLY_IF_RO} and
5431 @code{ONLY_IF_RW} respectively.
5432
5433 @node Output Section Region
5434 @subsubsection Output Section Region
5435 @kindex >@var{region}
5436 @cindex section, assigning to memory region
5437 @cindex memory regions and sections
5438 You can assign a section to a previously defined region of memory by
5439 using @samp{>@var{region}}. @xref{MEMORY}.
5440
5441 Here is a simple example:
5442 @smallexample
5443 @group
5444 MEMORY @{ rom : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x1000 @}
5445 SECTIONS @{ ROM : @{ *(.text) @} >rom @}
5446 @end group
5447 @end smallexample
5448
5449 @node Output Section Phdr
5450 @subsubsection Output Section Phdr
5451 @kindex :@var{phdr}
5452 @cindex section, assigning to program header
5453 @cindex program headers and sections
5454 You can assign a section to a previously defined program segment by
5455 using @samp{:@var{phdr}}. @xref{PHDRS}. If a section is assigned to
5456 one or more segments, then all subsequent allocated sections will be
5457 assigned to those segments as well, unless they use an explicitly
5458 @code{:@var{phdr}} modifier. You can use @code{:NONE} to tell the
5459 linker to not put the section in any segment at all.
5460
5461 Here is a simple example:
5462 @smallexample
5463 @group
5464 PHDRS @{ text PT_LOAD ; @}
5465 SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text @}
5466 @end group
5467 @end smallexample
5468
5469 @node Output Section Fill
5470 @subsubsection Output Section Fill
5471 @kindex =@var{fillexp}
5472 @cindex section fill pattern
5473 @cindex fill pattern, entire section
5474 You can set the fill pattern for an entire section by using
5475 @samp{=@var{fillexp}}. @var{fillexp} is an expression
5476 (@pxref{Expressions}). Any otherwise unspecified regions of memory
5477 within the output section (for example, gaps left due to the required
5478 alignment of input sections) will be filled with the value, repeated as
5479 necessary. If the fill expression is a simple hex number, ie. a string
5480 of hex digit starting with @samp{0x} and without a trailing @samp{k} or @samp{M}, then
5481 an arbitrarily long sequence of hex digits can be used to specify the
5482 fill pattern; Leading zeros become part of the pattern too. For all
5483 other cases, including extra parentheses or a unary @code{+}, the fill
5484 pattern is the four least significant bytes of the value of the
5485 expression. In all cases, the number is big-endian.
5486
5487 You can also change the fill value with a @code{FILL} command in the
5488 output section commands; (@pxref{Output Section Data}).
5489
5490 Here is a simple example:
5491 @smallexample
5492 @group
5493 SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} =0x90909090 @}
5494 @end group
5495 @end smallexample
5496
5497 @node Overlay Description
5498 @subsection Overlay Description
5499 @kindex OVERLAY
5500 @cindex overlays
5501 An overlay description provides an easy way to describe sections which
5502 are to be loaded as part of a single memory image but are to be run at
5503 the same memory address. At run time, some sort of overlay manager will
5504 copy the overlaid sections in and out of the runtime memory address as
5505 required, perhaps by simply manipulating addressing bits. This approach
5506 can be useful, for example, when a certain region of memory is faster
5507 than another.
5508
5509 Overlays are described using the @code{OVERLAY} command. The
5510 @code{OVERLAY} command is used within a @code{SECTIONS} command, like an
5511 output section description. The full syntax of the @code{OVERLAY}
5512 command is as follows:
5513 @smallexample
5514 @group
5515 OVERLAY [@var{start}] : [NOCROSSREFS] [AT ( @var{ldaddr} )]
5516 @{
5517 @var{secname1}
5518 @{
5519 @var{output-section-command}
5520 @var{output-section-command}
5521 @dots{}
5522 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5523 @var{secname2}
5524 @{
5525 @var{output-section-command}
5526 @var{output-section-command}
5527 @dots{}
5528 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5529 @dots{}
5530 @} [>@var{region}] [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}] [,]
5531 @end group
5532 @end smallexample
5533
5534 Everything is optional except @code{OVERLAY} (a keyword), and each
5535 section must have a name (@var{secname1} and @var{secname2} above). The
5536 section definitions within the @code{OVERLAY} construct are identical to
5537 those within the general @code{SECTIONS} construct (@pxref{SECTIONS}),
5538 except that no addresses and no memory regions may be defined for
5539 sections within an @code{OVERLAY}.
5540
5541 The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fill} is used and
5542 the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
5543
5544 The sections are all defined with the same starting address. The load
5545 addresses of the sections are arranged such that they are consecutive in
5546 memory starting at the load address used for the @code{OVERLAY} as a
5547 whole (as with normal section definitions, the load address is optional,
5548 and defaults to the start address; the start address is also optional,
5549 and defaults to the current value of the location counter).
5550
5551 If the @code{NOCROSSREFS} keyword is used, and there are any
5552 references among the sections, the linker will report an error. Since
5553 the sections all run at the same address, it normally does not make
5554 sense for one section to refer directly to another.
5555 @xref{Miscellaneous Commands, NOCROSSREFS}.
5556
5557 For each section within the @code{OVERLAY}, the linker automatically
5558 provides two symbols. The symbol @code{__load_start_@var{secname}} is
5559 defined as the starting load address of the section. The symbol
5560 @code{__load_stop_@var{secname}} is defined as the final load address of
5561 the section. Any characters within @var{secname} which are not legal
5562 within C identifiers are removed. C (or assembler) code may use these
5563 symbols to move the overlaid sections around as necessary.
5564
5565 At the end of the overlay, the value of the location counter is set to
5566 the start address of the overlay plus the size of the largest section.
5567
5568 Here is an example. Remember that this would appear inside a
5569 @code{SECTIONS} construct.
5570 @smallexample
5571 @group
5572 OVERLAY 0x1000 : AT (0x4000)
5573 @{
5574 .text0 @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
5575 .text1 @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
5576 @}
5577 @end group
5578 @end smallexample
5579 @noindent
5580 This will define both @samp{.text0} and @samp{.text1} to start at
5581 address 0x1000. @samp{.text0} will be loaded at address 0x4000, and
5582 @samp{.text1} will be loaded immediately after @samp{.text0}. The
5583 following symbols will be defined if referenced: @code{__load_start_text0},
5584 @code{__load_stop_text0}, @code{__load_start_text1},
5585 @code{__load_stop_text1}.
5586
5587 C code to copy overlay @code{.text1} into the overlay area might look
5588 like the following.
5589
5590 @smallexample
5591 @group
5592 extern char __load_start_text1, __load_stop_text1;
5593 memcpy ((char *) 0x1000, &__load_start_text1,
5594 &__load_stop_text1 - &__load_start_text1);
5595 @end group
5596 @end smallexample
5597
5598 Note that the @code{OVERLAY} command is just syntactic sugar, since
5599 everything it does can be done using the more basic commands. The above
5600 example could have been written identically as follows.
5601
5602 @smallexample
5603 @group
5604 .text0 0x1000 : AT (0x4000) @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
5605 PROVIDE (__load_start_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0));
5606 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0) + SIZEOF (.text0));
5607 .text1 0x1000 : AT (0x4000 + SIZEOF (.text0)) @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
5608 PROVIDE (__load_start_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1));
5609 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1) + SIZEOF (.text1));
5610 . = 0x1000 + MAX (SIZEOF (.text0), SIZEOF (.text1));
5611 @end group
5612 @end smallexample
5613
5614 @node MEMORY
5615 @section MEMORY Command
5616 @kindex MEMORY
5617 @cindex memory regions
5618 @cindex regions of memory
5619 @cindex allocating memory
5620 @cindex discontinuous memory
5621 The linker's default configuration permits allocation of all available
5622 memory. You can override this by using the @code{MEMORY} command.
5623
5624 The @code{MEMORY} command describes the location and size of blocks of
5625 memory in the target. You can use it to describe which memory regions
5626 may be used by the linker, and which memory regions it must avoid. You
5627 can then assign sections to particular memory regions. The linker will
5628 set section addresses based on the memory regions, and will warn about
5629 regions that become too full. The linker will not shuffle sections
5630 around to fit into the available regions.
5631
5632 A linker script may contain many uses of the @code{MEMORY} command,
5633 however, all memory blocks defined are treated as if they were
5634 specified inside a single @code{MEMORY} command. The syntax for
5635 @code{MEMORY} is:
5636 @smallexample
5637 @group
5638 MEMORY
5639 @{
5640 @var{name} [(@var{attr})] : ORIGIN = @var{origin}, LENGTH = @var{len}
5641 @dots{}
5642 @}
5643 @end group
5644 @end smallexample
5645
5646 The @var{name} is a name used in the linker script to refer to the
5647 region. The region name has no meaning outside of the linker script.
5648 Region names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
5649 with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each memory region
5650 must have a distinct name within the @code{MEMORY} command. However you can
5651 add later alias names to existing memory regions with the @ref{REGION_ALIAS}
5652 command.
5653
5654 @cindex memory region attributes
5655 The @var{attr} string is an optional list of attributes that specify
5656 whether to use a particular memory region for an input section which is
5657 not explicitly mapped in the linker script. As described in
5658 @ref{SECTIONS}, if you do not specify an output section for some input
5659 section, the linker will create an output section with the same name as
5660 the input section. If you define region attributes, the linker will use
5661 them to select the memory region for the output section that it creates.
5662
5663 The @var{attr} string must consist only of the following characters:
5664 @table @samp
5665 @item R
5666 Read-only section
5667 @item W
5668 Read/write section
5669 @item X
5670 Executable section
5671 @item A
5672 Allocatable section
5673 @item I
5674 Initialized section
5675 @item L
5676 Same as @samp{I}
5677 @item !
5678 Invert the sense of any of the attributes that follow
5679 @end table
5680
5681 If an unmapped section matches any of the listed attributes other than
5682 @samp{!}, it will be placed in the memory region. The @samp{!}
5683 attribute reverses the test for the characters that follow, so that an
5684 unmapped section will be placed in the memory region only if it does
5685 not match any of the attributes listed afterwards. Thus an attribute
5686 string of @samp{RW!X} will match any unmapped section that has either
5687 or both of the @samp{R} and @samp{W} attributes, but only as long as
5688 the section does not also have the @samp{X} attribute.
5689
5690 @kindex ORIGIN =
5691 @kindex o =
5692 @kindex org =
5693 The @var{origin} is an numerical expression for the start address of
5694 the memory region. The expression must evaluate to a constant and it
5695 cannot involve any symbols. The keyword @code{ORIGIN} may be
5696 abbreviated to @code{org} or @code{o} (but not, for example,
5697 @code{ORG}).
5698
5699 @kindex LENGTH =
5700 @kindex len =
5701 @kindex l =
5702 The @var{len} is an expression for the size in bytes of the memory
5703 region. As with the @var{origin} expression, the expression must
5704 be numerical only and must evaluate to a constant. The keyword
5705 @code{LENGTH} may be abbreviated to @code{len} or @code{l}.
5706
5707 In the following example, we specify that there are two memory regions
5708 available for allocation: one starting at @samp{0} for 256 kilobytes,
5709 and the other starting at @samp{0x40000000} for four megabytes. The
5710 linker will place into the @samp{rom} memory region every section which
5711 is not explicitly mapped into a memory region, and is either read-only
5712 or executable. The linker will place other sections which are not
5713 explicitly mapped into a memory region into the @samp{ram} memory
5714 region.
5715
5716 @smallexample
5717 @group
5718 MEMORY
5719 @{
5720 rom (rx) : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 256K
5721 ram (!rx) : org = 0x40000000, l = 4M
5722 @}
5723 @end group
5724 @end smallexample
5725
5726 Once you define a memory region, you can direct the linker to place
5727 specific output sections into that memory region by using the
5728 @samp{>@var{region}} output section attribute. For example, if you have
5729 a memory region named @samp{mem}, you would use @samp{>mem} in the
5730 output section definition. @xref{Output Section Region}. If no address
5731 was specified for the output section, the linker will set the address to
5732 the next available address within the memory region. If the combined
5733 output sections directed to a memory region are too large for the
5734 region, the linker will issue an error message.
5735
5736 It is possible to access the origin and length of a memory in an
5737 expression via the @code{ORIGIN(@var{memory})} and
5738 @code{LENGTH(@var{memory})} functions:
5739
5740 @smallexample
5741 @group
5742 _fstack = ORIGIN(ram) + LENGTH(ram) - 4;
5743 @end group
5744 @end smallexample
5745
5746 @node PHDRS
5747 @section PHDRS Command
5748 @kindex PHDRS
5749 @cindex program headers
5750 @cindex ELF program headers
5751 @cindex program segments
5752 @cindex segments, ELF
5753 The ELF object file format uses @dfn{program headers}, also knows as
5754 @dfn{segments}. The program headers describe how the program should be
5755 loaded into memory. You can print them out by using the @code{objdump}
5756 program with the @samp{-p} option.
5757
5758 When you run an ELF program on a native ELF system, the system loader
5759 reads the program headers in order to figure out how to load the
5760 program. This will only work if the program headers are set correctly.
5761 This manual does not describe the details of how the system loader
5762 interprets program headers; for more information, see the ELF ABI.
5763
5764 The linker will create reasonable program headers by default. However,
5765 in some cases, you may need to specify the program headers more
5766 precisely. You may use the @code{PHDRS} command for this purpose. When
5767 the linker sees the @code{PHDRS} command in the linker script, it will
5768 not create any program headers other than the ones specified.
5769
5770 The linker only pays attention to the @code{PHDRS} command when
5771 generating an ELF output file. In other cases, the linker will simply
5772 ignore @code{PHDRS}.
5773
5774 This is the syntax of the @code{PHDRS} command. The words @code{PHDRS},
5775 @code{FILEHDR}, @code{AT}, and @code{FLAGS} are keywords.
5776
5777 @smallexample
5778 @group
5779 PHDRS
5780 @{
5781 @var{name} @var{type} [ FILEHDR ] [ PHDRS ] [ AT ( @var{address} ) ]
5782 [ FLAGS ( @var{flags} ) ] ;
5783 @}
5784 @end group
5785 @end smallexample
5786
5787 The @var{name} is used only for reference in the @code{SECTIONS} command
5788 of the linker script. It is not put into the output file. Program
5789 header names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
5790 with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each program header
5791 must have a distinct name. The headers are processed in order and it
5792 is usual for them to map to sections in ascending load address order.
5793
5794 Certain program header types describe segments of memory which the
5795 system loader will load from the file. In the linker script, you
5796 specify the contents of these segments by placing allocatable output
5797 sections in the segments. You use the @samp{:@var{phdr}} output section
5798 attribute to place a section in a particular segment. @xref{Output
5799 Section Phdr}.
5800
5801 It is normal to put certain sections in more than one segment. This
5802 merely implies that one segment of memory contains another. You may
5803 repeat @samp{:@var{phdr}}, using it once for each segment which should
5804 contain the section.
5805
5806 If you place a section in one or more segments using @samp{:@var{phdr}},
5807 then the linker will place all subsequent allocatable sections which do
5808 not specify @samp{:@var{phdr}} in the same segments. This is for
5809 convenience, since generally a whole set of contiguous sections will be
5810 placed in a single segment. You can use @code{:NONE} to override the
5811 default segment and tell the linker to not put the section in any
5812 segment at all.
5813
5814 @kindex FILEHDR
5815 @kindex PHDRS
5816 You may use the @code{FILEHDR} and @code{PHDRS} keywords after
5817 the program header type to further describe the contents of the segment.
5818 The @code{FILEHDR} keyword means that the segment should include the ELF
5819 file header. The @code{PHDRS} keyword means that the segment should
5820 include the ELF program headers themselves. If applied to a loadable
5821 segment (@code{PT_LOAD}), all prior loadable segments must have one of
5822 these keywords.
5823
5824 The @var{type} may be one of the following. The numbers indicate the
5825 value of the keyword.
5826
5827 @table @asis
5828 @item @code{PT_NULL} (0)
5829 Indicates an unused program header.
5830
5831 @item @code{PT_LOAD} (1)
5832 Indicates that this program header describes a segment to be loaded from
5833 the file.
5834
5835 @item @code{PT_DYNAMIC} (2)
5836 Indicates a segment where dynamic linking information can be found.
5837
5838 @item @code{PT_INTERP} (3)
5839 Indicates a segment where the name of the program interpreter may be
5840 found.
5841
5842 @item @code{PT_NOTE} (4)
5843 Indicates a segment holding note information.
5844
5845 @item @code{PT_SHLIB} (5)
5846 A reserved program header type, defined but not specified by the ELF
5847 ABI.
5848
5849 @item @code{PT_PHDR} (6)
5850 Indicates a segment where the program headers may be found.
5851
5852 @item @code{PT_TLS} (7)
5853 Indicates a segment containing thread local storage.
5854
5855 @item @var{expression}
5856 An expression giving the numeric type of the program header. This may
5857 be used for types not defined above.
5858 @end table
5859
5860 You can specify that a segment should be loaded at a particular address
5861 in memory by using an @code{AT} expression. This is identical to the
5862 @code{AT} command used as an output section attribute (@pxref{Output
5863 Section LMA}). The @code{AT} command for a program header overrides the
5864 output section attribute.
5865
5866 The linker will normally set the segment flags based on the sections
5867 which comprise the segment. You may use the @code{FLAGS} keyword to
5868 explicitly specify the segment flags. The value of @var{flags} must be
5869 an integer. It is used to set the @code{p_flags} field of the program
5870 header.
5871
5872 Here is an example of @code{PHDRS}. This shows a typical set of program
5873 headers used on a native ELF system.
5874
5875 @example
5876 @group
5877 PHDRS
5878 @{
5879 headers PT_PHDR PHDRS ;
5880 interp PT_INTERP ;
5881 text PT_LOAD FILEHDR PHDRS ;
5882 data PT_LOAD ;
5883 dynamic PT_DYNAMIC ;
5884 @}
5885
5886 SECTIONS
5887 @{
5888 . = SIZEOF_HEADERS;
5889 .interp : @{ *(.interp) @} :text :interp
5890 .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text
5891 .rodata : @{ *(.rodata) @} /* defaults to :text */
5892 @dots{}
5893 . = . + 0x1000; /* move to a new page in memory */
5894 .data : @{ *(.data) @} :data
5895 .dynamic : @{ *(.dynamic) @} :data :dynamic
5896 @dots{}
5897 @}
5898 @end group
5899 @end example
5900
5901 @node VERSION
5902 @section VERSION Command
5903 @kindex VERSION @{script text@}
5904 @cindex symbol versions
5905 @cindex version script
5906 @cindex versions of symbols
5907 The linker supports symbol versions when using ELF. Symbol versions are
5908 only useful when using shared libraries. The dynamic linker can use
5909 symbol versions to select a specific version of a function when it runs
5910 a program that may have been linked against an earlier version of the
5911 shared library.
5912
5913 You can include a version script directly in the main linker script, or
5914 you can supply the version script as an implicit linker script. You can
5915 also use the @samp{--version-script} linker option.
5916
5917 The syntax of the @code{VERSION} command is simply
5918 @smallexample
5919 VERSION @{ version-script-commands @}
5920 @end smallexample
5921
5922 The format of the version script commands is identical to that used by
5923 Sun's linker in Solaris 2.5. The version script defines a tree of
5924 version nodes. You specify the node names and interdependencies in the
5925 version script. You can specify which symbols are bound to which
5926 version nodes, and you can reduce a specified set of symbols to local
5927 scope so that they are not globally visible outside of the shared
5928 library.
5929
5930 The easiest way to demonstrate the version script language is with a few
5931 examples.
5932
5933 @smallexample
5934 VERS_1.1 @{
5935 global:
5936 foo1;
5937 local:
5938 old*;
5939 original*;
5940 new*;
5941 @};
5942
5943 VERS_1.2 @{
5944 foo2;
5945 @} VERS_1.1;
5946
5947 VERS_2.0 @{
5948 bar1; bar2;
5949 extern "C++" @{
5950 ns::*;
5951 "f(int, double)";
5952 @};
5953 @} VERS_1.2;
5954 @end smallexample
5955
5956 This example version script defines three version nodes. The first
5957 version node defined is @samp{VERS_1.1}; it has no other dependencies.
5958 The script binds the symbol @samp{foo1} to @samp{VERS_1.1}. It reduces
5959 a number of symbols to local scope so that they are not visible outside
5960 of the shared library; this is done using wildcard patterns, so that any
5961 symbol whose name begins with @samp{old}, @samp{original}, or @samp{new}
5962 is matched. The wildcard patterns available are the same as those used
5963 in the shell when matching filenames (also known as ``globbing'').
5964 However, if you specify the symbol name inside double quotes, then the
5965 name is treated as literal, rather than as a glob pattern.
5966
5967 Next, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_1.2}. This node
5968 depends upon @samp{VERS_1.1}. The script binds the symbol @samp{foo2}
5969 to the version node @samp{VERS_1.2}.
5970
5971 Finally, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_2.0}. This node
5972 depends upon @samp{VERS_1.2}. The scripts binds the symbols @samp{bar1}
5973 and @samp{bar2} are bound to the version node @samp{VERS_2.0}.
5974
5975 When the linker finds a symbol defined in a library which is not
5976 specifically bound to a version node, it will effectively bind it to an
5977 unspecified base version of the library. You can bind all otherwise
5978 unspecified symbols to a given version node by using @samp{global: *;}
5979 somewhere in the version script. Note that it's slightly crazy to use
5980 wildcards in a global spec except on the last version node. Global
5981 wildcards elsewhere run the risk of accidentally adding symbols to the
5982 set exported for an old version. That's wrong since older versions
5983 ought to have a fixed set of symbols.
5984
5985 The names of the version nodes have no specific meaning other than what
5986 they might suggest to the person reading them. The @samp{2.0} version
5987 could just as well have appeared in between @samp{1.1} and @samp{1.2}.
5988 However, this would be a confusing way to write a version script.
5989
5990 Node name can be omitted, provided it is the only version node
5991 in the version script. Such version script doesn't assign any versions to
5992 symbols, only selects which symbols will be globally visible out and which
5993 won't.
5994
5995 @smallexample
5996 @{ global: foo; bar; local: *; @};
5997 @end smallexample
5998
5999 When you link an application against a shared library that has versioned
6000 symbols, the application itself knows which version of each symbol it
6001 requires, and it also knows which version nodes it needs from each
6002 shared library it is linked against. Thus at runtime, the dynamic
6003 loader can make a quick check to make sure that the libraries you have
6004 linked against do in fact supply all of the version nodes that the
6005 application will need to resolve all of the dynamic symbols. In this
6006 way it is possible for the dynamic linker to know with certainty that
6007 all external symbols that it needs will be resolvable without having to
6008 search for each symbol reference.
6009
6010 The symbol versioning is in effect a much more sophisticated way of
6011 doing minor version checking that SunOS does. The fundamental problem
6012 that is being addressed here is that typically references to external
6013 functions are bound on an as-needed basis, and are not all bound when
6014 the application starts up. If a shared library is out of date, a
6015 required interface may be missing; when the application tries to use
6016 that interface, it may suddenly and unexpectedly fail. With symbol
6017 versioning, the user will get a warning when they start their program if
6018 the libraries being used with the application are too old.
6019
6020 There are several GNU extensions to Sun's versioning approach. The
6021 first of these is the ability to bind a symbol to a version node in the
6022 source file where the symbol is defined instead of in the versioning
6023 script. This was done mainly to reduce the burden on the library
6024 maintainer. You can do this by putting something like:
6025 @smallexample
6026 __asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6027 @end smallexample
6028 @noindent
6029 in the C source file. This renames the function @samp{original_foo} to
6030 be an alias for @samp{foo} bound to the version node @samp{VERS_1.1}.
6031 The @samp{local:} directive can be used to prevent the symbol
6032 @samp{original_foo} from being exported. A @samp{.symver} directive
6033 takes precedence over a version script.
6034
6035 The second GNU extension is to allow multiple versions of the same
6036 function to appear in a given shared library. In this way you can make
6037 an incompatible change to an interface without increasing the major
6038 version number of the shared library, while still allowing applications
6039 linked against the old interface to continue to function.
6040
6041 To do this, you must use multiple @samp{.symver} directives in the
6042 source file. Here is an example:
6043
6044 @smallexample
6045 __asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@");
6046 __asm__(".symver old_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6047 __asm__(".symver old_foo1,foo@@VERS_1.2");
6048 __asm__(".symver new_foo,foo@@@@VERS_2.0");
6049 @end smallexample
6050
6051 In this example, @samp{foo@@} represents the symbol @samp{foo} bound to the
6052 unspecified base version of the symbol. The source file that contains this
6053 example would define 4 C functions: @samp{original_foo}, @samp{old_foo},
6054 @samp{old_foo1}, and @samp{new_foo}.
6055
6056 When you have multiple definitions of a given symbol, there needs to be
6057 some way to specify a default version to which external references to
6058 this symbol will be bound. You can do this with the
6059 @samp{foo@@@@VERS_2.0} type of @samp{.symver} directive. You can only
6060 declare one version of a symbol as the default in this manner; otherwise
6061 you would effectively have multiple definitions of the same symbol.
6062
6063 If you wish to bind a reference to a specific version of the symbol
6064 within the shared library, you can use the aliases of convenience
6065 (i.e., @samp{old_foo}), or you can use the @samp{.symver} directive to
6066 specifically bind to an external version of the function in question.
6067
6068 You can also specify the language in the version script:
6069
6070 @smallexample
6071 VERSION extern "lang" @{ version-script-commands @}
6072 @end smallexample
6073
6074 The supported @samp{lang}s are @samp{C}, @samp{C++}, and @samp{Java}.
6075 The linker will iterate over the list of symbols at the link time and
6076 demangle them according to @samp{lang} before matching them to the
6077 patterns specified in @samp{version-script-commands}. The default
6078 @samp{lang} is @samp{C}.
6079
6080 Demangled names may contains spaces and other special characters. As
6081 described above, you can use a glob pattern to match demangled names,
6082 or you can use a double-quoted string to match the string exactly. In
6083 the latter case, be aware that minor differences (such as differing
6084 whitespace) between the version script and the demangler output will
6085 cause a mismatch. As the exact string generated by the demangler
6086 might change in the future, even if the mangled name does not, you
6087 should check that all of your version directives are behaving as you
6088 expect when you upgrade.
6089
6090 @node Expressions
6091 @section Expressions in Linker Scripts
6092 @cindex expressions
6093 @cindex arithmetic
6094 The syntax for expressions in the linker script language is identical to
6095 that of C expressions. All expressions are evaluated as integers. All
6096 expressions are evaluated in the same size, which is 32 bits if both the
6097 host and target are 32 bits, and is otherwise 64 bits.
6098
6099 You can use and set symbol values in expressions.
6100
6101 The linker defines several special purpose builtin functions for use in
6102 expressions.
6103
6104 @menu
6105 * Constants:: Constants
6106 * Symbolic Constants:: Symbolic constants
6107 * Symbols:: Symbol Names
6108 * Orphan Sections:: Orphan Sections
6109 * Location Counter:: The Location Counter
6110 * Operators:: Operators
6111 * Evaluation:: Evaluation
6112 * Expression Section:: The Section of an Expression
6113 * Builtin Functions:: Builtin Functions
6114 @end menu
6115
6116 @node Constants
6117 @subsection Constants
6118 @cindex integer notation
6119 @cindex constants in linker scripts
6120 All constants are integers.
6121
6122 As in C, the linker considers an integer beginning with @samp{0} to be
6123 octal, and an integer beginning with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X} to be
6124 hexadecimal. Alternatively the linker accepts suffixes of @samp{h} or
6125 @samp{H} for hexadecimal, @samp{o} or @samp{O} for octal, @samp{b} or
6126 @samp{B} for binary and @samp{d} or @samp{D} for decimal. Any integer
6127 value without a prefix or a suffix is considered to be decimal.
6128
6129 @cindex scaled integers
6130 @cindex K and M integer suffixes
6131 @cindex M and K integer suffixes
6132 @cindex suffixes for integers
6133 @cindex integer suffixes
6134 In addition, you can use the suffixes @code{K} and @code{M} to scale a
6135 constant by
6136 @c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6137 @ifnottex
6138 @c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6139 @code{1024} or @code{1024*1024}
6140 @c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6141 @end ifnottex
6142 @tex
6143 ${\rm 1024}$ or ${\rm 1024}^2$
6144 @end tex
6145 @c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6146 respectively. For example, the following
6147 all refer to the same quantity:
6148
6149 @smallexample
6150 _fourk_1 = 4K;
6151 _fourk_2 = 4096;
6152 _fourk_3 = 0x1000;
6153 _fourk_4 = 10000o;
6154 @end smallexample
6155
6156 Note - the @code{K} and @code{M} suffixes cannot be used in
6157 conjunction with the base suffixes mentioned above.
6158
6159 @node Symbolic Constants
6160 @subsection Symbolic Constants
6161 @cindex symbolic constants
6162 @kindex CONSTANT
6163 It is possible to refer to target-specific constants via the use of
6164 the @code{CONSTANT(@var{name})} operator, where @var{name} is one of:
6165
6166 @table @code
6167 @item MAXPAGESIZE
6168 @kindex MAXPAGESIZE
6169 The target's maximum page size.
6170
6171 @item COMMONPAGESIZE
6172 @kindex COMMONPAGESIZE
6173 The target's default page size.
6174 @end table
6175
6176 So for example:
6177
6178 @smallexample
6179 .text ALIGN (CONSTANT (MAXPAGESIZE)) : @{ *(.text) @}
6180 @end smallexample
6181
6182 will create a text section aligned to the largest page boundary
6183 supported by the target.
6184
6185 @node Symbols
6186 @subsection Symbol Names
6187 @cindex symbol names
6188 @cindex names
6189 @cindex quoted symbol names
6190 @kindex "
6191 Unless quoted, symbol names start with a letter, underscore, or period
6192 and may include letters, digits, underscores, periods, and hyphens.
6193 Unquoted symbol names must not conflict with any keywords. You can
6194 specify a symbol which contains odd characters or has the same name as a
6195 keyword by surrounding the symbol name in double quotes:
6196 @smallexample
6197 "SECTION" = 9;
6198 "with a space" = "also with a space" + 10;
6199 @end smallexample
6200
6201 Since symbols can contain many non-alphabetic characters, it is safest
6202 to delimit symbols with spaces. For example, @samp{A-B} is one symbol,
6203 whereas @samp{A - B} is an expression involving subtraction.
6204
6205 @node Orphan Sections
6206 @subsection Orphan Sections
6207 @cindex orphan
6208 Orphan sections are sections present in the input files which
6209 are not explicitly placed into the output file by the linker
6210 script. The linker will still copy these sections into the
6211 output file by either finding, or creating a suitable output section
6212 in which to place the orphaned input section.
6213
6214 If the name of an orphaned input section exactly matches the name of
6215 an existing output section, then the orphaned input section will be
6216 placed at the end of that output section.
6217
6218 If there is no output section with a matching name then new output
6219 sections will be created. Each new output section will have the same
6220 name as the orphan section placed within it. If there are multiple
6221 orphan sections with the same name, these will all be combined into
6222 one new output section.
6223
6224 If new output sections are created to hold orphaned input sections,
6225 then the linker must decide where to place these new output sections
6226 in relation to existing output sections. On most modern targets, the
6227 linker attempts to place orphan sections after sections of the same
6228 attribute, such as code vs data, loadable vs non-loadable, etc. If no
6229 sections with matching attributes are found, or your target lacks this
6230 support, the orphan section is placed at the end of the file.
6231
6232 The command-line options @samp{--orphan-handling} and @samp{--unique}
6233 (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}) can be used to control which
6234 output sections an orphan is placed in.
6235
6236 @node Location Counter
6237 @subsection The Location Counter
6238 @kindex .
6239 @cindex dot
6240 @cindex location counter
6241 @cindex current output location
6242 The special linker variable @dfn{dot} @samp{.} always contains the
6243 current output location counter. Since the @code{.} always refers to a
6244 location in an output section, it may only appear in an expression
6245 within a @code{SECTIONS} command. The @code{.} symbol may appear
6246 anywhere that an ordinary symbol is allowed in an expression.
6247
6248 @cindex holes
6249 Assigning a value to @code{.} will cause the location counter to be
6250 moved. This may be used to create holes in the output section. The
6251 location counter may not be moved backwards inside an output section,
6252 and may not be moved backwards outside of an output section if so
6253 doing creates areas with overlapping LMAs.
6254
6255 @smallexample
6256 SECTIONS
6257 @{
6258 output :
6259 @{
6260 file1(.text)
6261 . = . + 1000;
6262 file2(.text)
6263 . += 1000;
6264 file3(.text)
6265 @} = 0x12345678;
6266 @}
6267 @end smallexample
6268 @noindent
6269 In the previous example, the @samp{.text} section from @file{file1} is
6270 located at the beginning of the output section @samp{output}. It is
6271 followed by a 1000 byte gap. Then the @samp{.text} section from
6272 @file{file2} appears, also with a 1000 byte gap following before the
6273 @samp{.text} section from @file{file3}. The notation @samp{= 0x12345678}
6274 specifies what data to write in the gaps (@pxref{Output Section Fill}).
6275
6276 @cindex dot inside sections
6277 Note: @code{.} actually refers to the byte offset from the start of the
6278 current containing object. Normally this is the @code{SECTIONS}
6279 statement, whose start address is 0, hence @code{.} can be used as an
6280 absolute address. If @code{.} is used inside a section description
6281 however, it refers to the byte offset from the start of that section,
6282 not an absolute address. Thus in a script like this:
6283
6284 @smallexample
6285 SECTIONS
6286 @{
6287 . = 0x100
6288 .text: @{
6289 *(.text)
6290 . = 0x200
6291 @}
6292 . = 0x500
6293 .data: @{
6294 *(.data)
6295 . += 0x600
6296 @}
6297 @}
6298 @end smallexample
6299
6300 The @samp{.text} section will be assigned a starting address of 0x100
6301 and a size of exactly 0x200 bytes, even if there is not enough data in
6302 the @samp{.text} input sections to fill this area. (If there is too
6303 much data, an error will be produced because this would be an attempt to
6304 move @code{.} backwards). The @samp{.data} section will start at 0x500
6305 and it will have an extra 0x600 bytes worth of space after the end of
6306 the values from the @samp{.data} input sections and before the end of
6307 the @samp{.data} output section itself.
6308
6309 @cindex dot outside sections
6310 Setting symbols to the value of the location counter outside of an
6311 output section statement can result in unexpected values if the linker
6312 needs to place orphan sections. For example, given the following:
6313
6314 @smallexample
6315 SECTIONS
6316 @{
6317 start_of_text = . ;
6318 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6319 end_of_text = . ;
6320
6321 start_of_data = . ;
6322 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6323 end_of_data = . ;
6324 @}
6325 @end smallexample
6326
6327 If the linker needs to place some input section, e.g. @code{.rodata},
6328 not mentioned in the script, it might choose to place that section
6329 between @code{.text} and @code{.data}. You might think the linker
6330 should place @code{.rodata} on the blank line in the above script, but
6331 blank lines are of no particular significance to the linker. As well,
6332 the linker doesn't associate the above symbol names with their
6333 sections. Instead, it assumes that all assignments or other
6334 statements belong to the previous output section, except for the
6335 special case of an assignment to @code{.}. I.e., the linker will
6336 place the orphan @code{.rodata} section as if the script was written
6337 as follows:
6338
6339 @smallexample
6340 SECTIONS
6341 @{
6342 start_of_text = . ;
6343 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6344 end_of_text = . ;
6345
6346 start_of_data = . ;
6347 .rodata: @{ *(.rodata) @}
6348 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6349 end_of_data = . ;
6350 @}
6351 @end smallexample
6352
6353 This may or may not be the script author's intention for the value of
6354 @code{start_of_data}. One way to influence the orphan section
6355 placement is to assign the location counter to itself, as the linker
6356 assumes that an assignment to @code{.} is setting the start address of
6357 a following output section and thus should be grouped with that
6358 section. So you could write:
6359
6360 @smallexample
6361 SECTIONS
6362 @{
6363 start_of_text = . ;
6364 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6365 end_of_text = . ;
6366
6367 . = . ;
6368 start_of_data = . ;
6369 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6370 end_of_data = . ;
6371 @}
6372 @end smallexample
6373
6374 Now, the orphan @code{.rodata} section will be placed between
6375 @code{end_of_text} and @code{start_of_data}.
6376
6377 @need 2000
6378 @node Operators
6379 @subsection Operators
6380 @cindex operators for arithmetic
6381 @cindex arithmetic operators
6382 @cindex precedence in expressions
6383 The linker recognizes the standard C set of arithmetic operators, with
6384 the standard bindings and precedence levels:
6385 @c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6386 @ifnottex
6387 @c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6388 @smallexample
6389 precedence associativity Operators Notes
6390 (highest)
6391 1 left ! - ~ (1)
6392 2 left * / %
6393 3 left + -
6394 4 left >> <<
6395 5 left == != > < <= >=
6396 6 left &
6397 7 left |
6398 8 left &&
6399 9 left ||
6400 10 right ? :
6401 11 right &= += -= *= /= (2)
6402 (lowest)
6403 @end smallexample
6404 Notes:
6405 (1) Prefix operators
6406 (2) @xref{Assignments}.
6407 @c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6408 @end ifnottex
6409 @tex
6410 \vskip \baselineskip
6411 %"lispnarrowing" is the extra indent used generally for smallexample
6412 \hskip\lispnarrowing\vbox{\offinterlineskip
6413 \hrule
6414 \halign
6415 {\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ {\tt #}\ \hfil&\vrule#\cr
6416 height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6417 &Precedence&& Associativity &&{\rm Operators}&\cr
6418 height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6419 \noalign{\hrule}
6420 height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6421 &highest&&&&&\cr
6422 % '176 is tilde, '~' in tt font
6423 &1&&left&&\qquad- \char'176\ !\qquad\dag&\cr
6424 &2&&left&&* / \%&\cr
6425 &3&&left&&+ -&\cr
6426 &4&&left&&>> <<&\cr
6427 &5&&left&&== != > < <= >=&\cr
6428 &6&&left&&\&&\cr
6429 &7&&left&&|&\cr
6430 &8&&left&&{\&\&}&\cr
6431 &9&&left&&||&\cr
6432 &10&&right&&? :&\cr
6433 &11&&right&&\qquad\&= += -= *= /=\qquad\ddag&\cr
6434 &lowest&&&&&\cr
6435 height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr}
6436 \hrule}
6437 @end tex
6438 @iftex
6439 {
6440 @obeylines@parskip=0pt@parindent=0pt
6441 @dag@quad Prefix operators.
6442 @ddag@quad @xref{Assignments}.
6443 }
6444 @end iftex
6445 @c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6446
6447 @node Evaluation
6448 @subsection Evaluation
6449 @cindex lazy evaluation
6450 @cindex expression evaluation order
6451 The linker evaluates expressions lazily. It only computes the value of
6452 an expression when absolutely necessary.
6453
6454 The linker needs some information, such as the value of the start
6455 address of the first section, and the origins and lengths of memory
6456 regions, in order to do any linking at all. These values are computed
6457 as soon as possible when the linker reads in the linker script.
6458
6459 However, other values (such as symbol values) are not known or needed
6460 until after storage allocation. Such values are evaluated later, when
6461 other information (such as the sizes of output sections) is available
6462 for use in the symbol assignment expression.
6463
6464 The sizes of sections cannot be known until after allocation, so
6465 assignments dependent upon these are not performed until after
6466 allocation.
6467
6468 Some expressions, such as those depending upon the location counter
6469 @samp{.}, must be evaluated during section allocation.
6470
6471 If the result of an expression is required, but the value is not
6472 available, then an error results. For example, a script like the
6473 following
6474 @smallexample
6475 @group
6476 SECTIONS
6477 @{
6478 .text 9+this_isnt_constant :
6479 @{ *(.text) @}
6480 @}
6481 @end group
6482 @end smallexample
6483 @noindent
6484 will cause the error message @samp{non constant expression for initial
6485 address}.
6486
6487 @node Expression Section
6488 @subsection The Section of an Expression
6489 @cindex expression sections
6490 @cindex absolute expressions
6491 @cindex relative expressions
6492 @cindex absolute and relocatable symbols
6493 @cindex relocatable and absolute symbols
6494 @cindex symbols, relocatable and absolute
6495 Addresses and symbols may be section relative, or absolute. A section
6496 relative symbol is relocatable. If you request relocatable output
6497 using the @samp{-r} option, a further link operation may change the
6498 value of a section relative symbol. On the other hand, an absolute
6499 symbol will retain the same value throughout any further link
6500 operations.
6501
6502 Some terms in linker expressions are addresses. This is true of
6503 section relative symbols and for builtin functions that return an
6504 address, such as @code{ADDR}, @code{LOADADDR}, @code{ORIGIN} and
6505 @code{SEGMENT_START}. Other terms are simply numbers, or are builtin
6506 functions that return a non-address value, such as @code{LENGTH}.
6507 One complication is that unless you set @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")}
6508 (@pxref{Miscellaneous Commands}), numbers and absolute symbols are treated
6509 differently depending on their location, for compatibility with older
6510 versions of @code{ld}. Expressions appearing outside an output
6511 section definition treat all numbers as absolute addresses.
6512 Expressions appearing inside an output section definition treat
6513 absolute symbols as numbers. If @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} is
6514 given, then absolute symbols and numbers are simply treated as numbers
6515 everywhere.
6516
6517 In the following simple example,
6518
6519 @smallexample
6520 @group
6521 SECTIONS
6522 @{
6523 . = 0x100;
6524 __executable_start = 0x100;
6525 .data :
6526 @{
6527 . = 0x10;
6528 __data_start = 0x10;
6529 *(.data)
6530 @}
6531 @dots{}
6532 @}
6533 @end group
6534 @end smallexample
6535
6536 both @code{.} and @code{__executable_start} are set to the absolute
6537 address 0x100 in the first two assignments, then both @code{.} and
6538 @code{__data_start} are set to 0x10 relative to the @code{.data}
6539 section in the second two assignments.
6540
6541 For expressions involving numbers, relative addresses and absolute
6542 addresses, ld follows these rules to evaluate terms:
6543
6544 @itemize @bullet
6545 @item
6546 Unary operations on an absolute address or number, and binary
6547 operations on two absolute addresses or two numbers, or between one
6548 absolute address and a number, apply the operator to the value(s).
6549 @item
6550 Unary operations on a relative address, and binary operations on two
6551 relative addresses in the same section or between one relative address
6552 and a number, apply the operator to the offset part of the address(es).
6553 @item
6554 Other binary operations, that is, between two relative addresses not
6555 in the same section, or between a relative address and an absolute
6556 address, first convert any non-absolute term to an absolute address
6557 before applying the operator.
6558 @end itemize
6559
6560 The result section of each sub-expression is as follows:
6561
6562 @itemize @bullet
6563 @item
6564 An operation involving only numbers results in a number.
6565 @item
6566 The result of comparisons, @samp{&&} and @samp{||} is also a number.
6567 @item
6568 The result of other binary arithmetic and logical operations on two
6569 relative addresses in the same section or two absolute addresses
6570 (after above conversions) is also a number when
6571 @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} or inside an output section definition
6572 but an absolute address otherwise.
6573 @item
6574 The result of other operations on relative addresses or one
6575 relative address and a number, is a relative address in the same
6576 section as the relative operand(s).
6577 @item
6578 The result of other operations on absolute addresses (after above
6579 conversions) is an absolute address.
6580 @end itemize
6581
6582 You can use the builtin function @code{ABSOLUTE} to force an expression
6583 to be absolute when it would otherwise be relative. For example, to
6584 create an absolute symbol set to the address of the end of the output
6585 section @samp{.data}:
6586 @smallexample
6587 SECTIONS
6588 @{
6589 .data : @{ *(.data) _edata = ABSOLUTE(.); @}
6590 @}
6591 @end smallexample
6592 @noindent
6593 If @samp{ABSOLUTE} were not used, @samp{_edata} would be relative to the
6594 @samp{.data} section.
6595
6596 Using @code{LOADADDR} also forces an expression absolute, since this
6597 particular builtin function returns an absolute address.
6598
6599 @node Builtin Functions
6600 @subsection Builtin Functions
6601 @cindex functions in expressions
6602 The linker script language includes a number of builtin functions for
6603 use in linker script expressions.
6604
6605 @table @code
6606 @item ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6607 @kindex ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6608 @cindex expression, absolute
6609 Return the absolute (non-relocatable, as opposed to non-negative) value
6610 of the expression @var{exp}. Primarily useful to assign an absolute
6611 value to a symbol within a section definition, where symbol values are
6612 normally section relative. @xref{Expression Section}.
6613
6614 @item ADDR(@var{section})
6615 @kindex ADDR(@var{section})
6616 @cindex section address in expression
6617 Return the address (VMA) of the named @var{section}. Your
6618 script must previously have defined the location of that section. In
6619 the following example, @code{start_of_output_1}, @code{symbol_1} and
6620 @code{symbol_2} are assigned equivalent values, except that
6621 @code{symbol_1} will be relative to the @code{.output1} section while
6622 the other two will be absolute:
6623 @smallexample
6624 @group
6625 SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6626 .output1 :
6627 @{
6628 start_of_output_1 = ABSOLUTE(.);
6629 @dots{}
6630 @}
6631 .output :
6632 @{
6633 symbol_1 = ADDR(.output1);
6634 symbol_2 = start_of_output_1;
6635 @}
6636 @dots{} @}
6637 @end group
6638 @end smallexample
6639
6640 @item ALIGN(@var{align})
6641 @itemx ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
6642 @kindex ALIGN(@var{align})
6643 @kindex ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
6644 @cindex round up location counter
6645 @cindex align location counter
6646 @cindex round up expression
6647 @cindex align expression
6648 Return the location counter (@code{.}) or arbitrary expression aligned
6649 to the next @var{align} boundary. The single operand @code{ALIGN}
6650 doesn't change the value of the location counter---it just does
6651 arithmetic on it. The two operand @code{ALIGN} allows an arbitrary
6652 expression to be aligned upwards (@code{ALIGN(@var{align})} is
6653 equivalent to @code{ALIGN(ABSOLUTE(.), @var{align})}).
6654
6655 Here is an example which aligns the output @code{.data} section to the
6656 next @code{0x2000} byte boundary after the preceding section and sets a
6657 variable within the section to the next @code{0x8000} boundary after the
6658 input sections:
6659 @smallexample
6660 @group
6661 SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6662 .data ALIGN(0x2000): @{
6663 *(.data)
6664 variable = ALIGN(0x8000);
6665 @}
6666 @dots{} @}
6667 @end group
6668 @end smallexample
6669 @noindent
6670 The first use of @code{ALIGN} in this example specifies the location of
6671 a section because it is used as the optional @var{address} attribute of
6672 a section definition (@pxref{Output Section Address}). The second use
6673 of @code{ALIGN} is used to defines the value of a symbol.
6674
6675 The builtin function @code{NEXT} is closely related to @code{ALIGN}.
6676
6677 @item ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6678 @kindex ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6679 @cindex section alignment
6680 Return the alignment in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
6681 been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
6682 evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
6683 the alignment of the @code{.output} section is stored as the first
6684 value in that section.
6685 @smallexample
6686 @group
6687 SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
6688 .output @{
6689 LONG (ALIGNOF (.output))
6690 @dots{}
6691 @}
6692 @dots{} @}
6693 @end group
6694 @end smallexample
6695
6696 @item BLOCK(@var{exp})
6697 @kindex BLOCK(@var{exp})
6698 This is a synonym for @code{ALIGN}, for compatibility with older linker
6699 scripts. It is most often seen when setting the address of an output
6700 section.
6701
6702 @item DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
6703 @kindex DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
6704 This is equivalent to either
6705 @smallexample
6706 (ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}) + (. & (@var{maxpagesize} - 1)))
6707 @end smallexample
6708 or
6709 @smallexample
6710 (ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize})
6711 + ((. + @var{commonpagesize} - 1) & (@var{maxpagesize} - @var{commonpagesize})))
6712 @end smallexample
6713 @noindent
6714 depending on whether the latter uses fewer @var{commonpagesize} sized pages
6715 for the data segment (area between the result of this expression and
6716 @code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}) than the former or not.
6717 If the latter form is used, it means @var{commonpagesize} bytes of runtime
6718 memory will be saved at the expense of up to @var{commonpagesize} wasted
6719 bytes in the on-disk file.
6720
6721 This expression can only be used directly in @code{SECTIONS} commands, not in
6722 any output section descriptions and only once in the linker script.
6723 @var{commonpagesize} should be less or equal to @var{maxpagesize} and should
6724 be the system page size the object wants to be optimized for while still
6725 running on system page sizes up to @var{maxpagesize}. Note however
6726 that @samp{-z relro} protection will not be effective if the system
6727 page size is larger than @var{commonpagesize}.
6728
6729 @noindent
6730 Example:
6731 @smallexample
6732 . = DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(0x10000, 0x2000);
6733 @end smallexample
6734
6735 @item DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
6736 @kindex DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
6737 This defines the end of data segment for @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}
6738 evaluation purposes.
6739
6740 @smallexample
6741 . = DATA_SEGMENT_END(.);
6742 @end smallexample
6743
6744 @item DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
6745 @kindex DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
6746 This defines the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment when
6747 @samp{-z relro} option is used.
6748 When @samp{-z relro} option is not present, @code{DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END}
6749 does nothing, otherwise @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} is padded so that
6750 @var{exp} + @var{offset} is aligned to the @var{commonpagesize}
6751 argument given to @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}. If present in the linker
6752 script, it must be placed between @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} and
6753 @code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}. Evaluates to the second argument plus any
6754 padding needed at the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment due to
6755 section alignment.
6756
6757 @smallexample
6758 . = DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(24, .);
6759 @end smallexample
6760
6761 @item DEFINED(@var{symbol})
6762 @kindex DEFINED(@var{symbol})
6763 @cindex symbol defaults
6764 Return 1 if @var{symbol} is in the linker global symbol table and is
6765 defined before the statement using DEFINED in the script, otherwise
6766 return 0. You can use this function to provide
6767 default values for symbols. For example, the following script fragment
6768 shows how to set a global symbol @samp{begin} to the first location in
6769 the @samp{.text} section---but if a symbol called @samp{begin} already
6770 existed, its value is preserved:
6771
6772 @smallexample
6773 @group
6774 SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6775 .text : @{
6776 begin = DEFINED(begin) ? begin : . ;
6777 @dots{}
6778 @}
6779 @dots{}
6780 @}
6781 @end group
6782 @end smallexample
6783
6784 @item LENGTH(@var{memory})
6785 @kindex LENGTH(@var{memory})
6786 Return the length of the memory region named @var{memory}.
6787
6788 @item LOADADDR(@var{section})
6789 @kindex LOADADDR(@var{section})
6790 @cindex section load address in expression
6791 Return the absolute LMA of the named @var{section}. (@pxref{Output
6792 Section LMA}).
6793
6794 @item LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
6795 @kindex LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
6796 Return the binary logarithm of @var{exp} rounded towards infinity.
6797 @code{LOG2CEIL(0)} returns 0.
6798
6799 @kindex MAX
6800 @item MAX(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
6801 Returns the maximum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
6802
6803 @kindex MIN
6804 @item MIN(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
6805 Returns the minimum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
6806
6807 @item NEXT(@var{exp})
6808 @kindex NEXT(@var{exp})
6809 @cindex unallocated address, next
6810 Return the next unallocated address that is a multiple of @var{exp}.
6811 This function is closely related to @code{ALIGN(@var{exp})}; unless you
6812 use the @code{MEMORY} command to define discontinuous memory for the
6813 output file, the two functions are equivalent.
6814
6815 @item ORIGIN(@var{memory})
6816 @kindex ORIGIN(@var{memory})
6817 Return the origin of the memory region named @var{memory}.
6818
6819 @item SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
6820 @kindex SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
6821 Return the base address of the named @var{segment}. If an explicit
6822 value has already been given for this segment (with a command-line
6823 @samp{-T} option) then that value will be returned otherwise the value
6824 will be @var{default}. At present, the @samp{-T} command-line option
6825 can only be used to set the base address for the ``text'', ``data'', and
6826 ``bss'' sections, but you can use @code{SEGMENT_START} with any segment
6827 name.
6828
6829 @item SIZEOF(@var{section})
6830 @kindex SIZEOF(@var{section})
6831 @cindex section size
6832 Return the size in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
6833 been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
6834 evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
6835 @code{symbol_1} and @code{symbol_2} are assigned identical values:
6836 @smallexample
6837 @group
6838 SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
6839 .output @{
6840 .start = . ;
6841 @dots{}
6842 .end = . ;
6843 @}
6844 symbol_1 = .end - .start ;
6845 symbol_2 = SIZEOF(.output);
6846 @dots{} @}
6847 @end group
6848 @end smallexample
6849
6850 @item SIZEOF_HEADERS
6851 @itemx sizeof_headers
6852 @kindex SIZEOF_HEADERS
6853 @cindex header size
6854 Return the size in bytes of the output file's headers. This is
6855 information which appears at the start of the output file. You can use
6856 this number when setting the start address of the first section, if you
6857 choose, to facilitate paging.
6858
6859 @cindex not enough room for program headers
6860 @cindex program headers, not enough room
6861 When producing an ELF output file, if the linker script uses the
6862 @code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} builtin function, the linker must compute the
6863 number of program headers before it has determined all the section
6864 addresses and sizes. If the linker later discovers that it needs
6865 additional program headers, it will report an error @samp{not enough
6866 room for program headers}. To avoid this error, you must avoid using
6867 the @code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} function, or you must rework your linker
6868 script to avoid forcing the linker to use additional program headers, or
6869 you must define the program headers yourself using the @code{PHDRS}
6870 command (@pxref{PHDRS}).
6871 @end table
6872
6873 @node Implicit Linker Scripts
6874 @section Implicit Linker Scripts
6875 @cindex implicit linker scripts
6876 If you specify a linker input file which the linker can not recognize as
6877 an object file or an archive file, it will try to read the file as a
6878 linker script. If the file can not be parsed as a linker script, the
6879 linker will report an error.
6880
6881 An implicit linker script will not replace the default linker script.
6882
6883 Typically an implicit linker script would contain only symbol
6884 assignments, or the @code{INPUT}, @code{GROUP}, or @code{VERSION}
6885 commands.
6886
6887 Any input files read because of an implicit linker script will be read
6888 at the position in the command line where the implicit linker script was
6889 read. This can affect archive searching.
6890
6891 @ifset GENERIC
6892 @node Machine Dependent
6893 @chapter Machine Dependent Features
6894
6895 @cindex machine dependencies
6896 @command{ld} has additional features on some platforms; the following
6897 sections describe them. Machines where @command{ld} has no additional
6898 functionality are not listed.
6899
6900 @menu
6901 @ifset H8300
6902 * H8/300:: @command{ld} and the H8/300
6903 @end ifset
6904 @ifset M68HC11
6905 * M68HC11/68HC12:: @code{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
6906 @end ifset
6907 @ifset ARM
6908 * ARM:: @command{ld} and the ARM family
6909 @end ifset
6910 @ifset HPPA
6911 * HPPA ELF32:: @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF
6912 @end ifset
6913 @ifset M68K
6914 * M68K:: @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
6915 @end ifset
6916 @ifset MIPS
6917 * MIPS:: @command{ld} and the MIPS family
6918 @end ifset
6919 @ifset MMIX
6920 * MMIX:: @command{ld} and MMIX
6921 @end ifset
6922 @ifset MSP430
6923 * MSP430:: @command{ld} and MSP430
6924 @end ifset
6925 @ifset NDS32
6926 * NDS32:: @command{ld} and NDS32
6927 @end ifset
6928 @ifset NIOSII
6929 * Nios II:: @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
6930 @end ifset
6931 @ifset POWERPC
6932 * PowerPC ELF32:: @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
6933 @end ifset
6934 @ifset POWERPC64
6935 * PowerPC64 ELF64:: @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
6936 @end ifset
6937 @ifset S/390
6938 * S/390 ELF:: @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
6939 @end ifset
6940 @ifset SPU
6941 * SPU ELF:: @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
6942 @end ifset
6943 @ifset TICOFF
6944 * TI COFF:: @command{ld} and TI COFF
6945 @end ifset
6946 @ifset WIN32
6947 * WIN32:: @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
6948 @end ifset
6949 @ifset XTENSA
6950 * Xtensa:: @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors
6951 @end ifset
6952 @end menu
6953 @end ifset
6954
6955 @ifset H8300
6956 @ifclear GENERIC
6957 @raisesections
6958 @end ifclear
6959
6960 @node H8/300
6961 @section @command{ld} and the H8/300
6962
6963 @cindex H8/300 support
6964 For the H8/300, @command{ld} can perform these global optimizations when
6965 you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
6966
6967 @table @emph
6968 @cindex relaxing on H8/300
6969 @item relaxing address modes
6970 @command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
6971 targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
6972 program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
6973 respectively.
6974
6975 @cindex synthesizing on H8/300
6976 @item synthesizing instructions
6977 @c FIXME: specifically mov.b, or any mov instructions really? -> mov.b only, at least on H8, H8H, H8S
6978 @command{ld} finds all @code{mov.b} instructions which use the
6979 sixteen-bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
6980 page of memory, and changes them to use the eight-bit address form.
6981 (That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:16} into
6982 @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in the
6983 top page of memory).
6984
6985 @command{ld} finds all @code{mov} instructions which use the register
6986 indirect with 32-bit displacement addressing mode, but use a small
6987 displacement inside 16-bit displacement range, and changes them to use
6988 the 16-bit displacement form. (That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b
6989 @code{@@}@var{d}:32,ERx} into @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{d}:16,ERx}
6990 whenever the displacement @var{d} is in the 16 bit signed integer
6991 range. Only implemented in ELF-format ld).
6992
6993 @item bit manipulation instructions
6994 @command{ld} finds all bit manipulation instructions like @code{band, bclr,
6995 biand, bild, bior, bist, bixor, bld, bnot, bor, bset, bst, btst, bxor}
6996 which use 32 bit and 16 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
6997 page of memory, and changes them to use the 8 bit address form.
6998 (That is: the linker turns @samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:32} into
6999 @samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
7000 the top page of memory).
7001
7002 @item system control instructions
7003 @command{ld} finds all @code{ldc.w, stc.w} instructions which use the
7004 32 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top page of memory, and
7005 changes them to use 16 bit address form.
7006 (That is: the linker turns @samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:32,ccr} into
7007 @samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:16,ccr} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
7008 the top page of memory).
7009 @end table
7010
7011 @ifclear GENERIC
7012 @lowersections
7013 @end ifclear
7014 @end ifset
7015
7016 @ifclear GENERIC
7017 @ifset Renesas
7018 @c This stuff is pointless to say unless you're especially concerned
7019 @c with Renesas chips; don't enable it for generic case, please.
7020 @node Renesas
7021 @chapter @command{ld} and Other Renesas Chips
7022
7023 @command{ld} also supports the Renesas (formerly Hitachi) H8/300H,
7024 H8/500, and SH chips. No special features, commands, or command-line
7025 options are required for these chips.
7026 @end ifset
7027 @end ifclear
7028
7029 @ifset ARM
7030 @ifclear GENERIC
7031 @raisesections
7032 @end ifclear
7033
7034 @ifset M68HC11
7035 @ifclear GENERIC
7036 @raisesections
7037 @end ifclear
7038
7039 @node M68HC11/68HC12
7040 @section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7041
7042 @cindex M68HC11 and 68HC12 support
7043
7044 @subsection Linker Relaxation
7045
7046 For the Motorola 68HC11, @command{ld} can perform these global
7047 optimizations when you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7048
7049 @table @emph
7050 @cindex relaxing on M68HC11
7051 @item relaxing address modes
7052 @command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
7053 targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7054 program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7055 respectively.
7056
7057 @command{ld} also looks at all 16-bit extended addressing modes and
7058 transforms them in a direct addressing mode when the address is in
7059 page 0 (between 0 and 0x0ff).
7060
7061 @item relaxing gcc instruction group
7062 When @command{gcc} is called with @option{-mrelax}, it can emit group
7063 of instructions that the linker can optimize to use a 68HC11 direct
7064 addressing mode. These instructions consists of @code{bclr} or
7065 @code{bset} instructions.
7066
7067 @end table
7068
7069 @subsection Trampoline Generation
7070
7071 @cindex trampoline generation on M68HC11
7072 @cindex trampoline generation on M68HC12
7073 For 68HC11 and 68HC12, @command{ld} can generate trampoline code to
7074 call a far function using a normal @code{jsr} instruction. The linker
7075 will also change the relocation to some far function to use the
7076 trampoline address instead of the function address. This is typically the
7077 case when a pointer to a function is taken. The pointer will in fact
7078 point to the function trampoline.
7079
7080 @ifclear GENERIC
7081 @lowersections
7082 @end ifclear
7083 @end ifset
7084
7085 @node ARM
7086 @section @command{ld} and the ARM family
7087
7088 @cindex ARM interworking support
7089 @kindex --support-old-code
7090 For the ARM, @command{ld} will generate code stubs to allow functions calls
7091 between ARM and Thumb code. These stubs only work with code that has
7092 been compiled and assembled with the @samp{-mthumb-interwork} command
7093 line option. If it is necessary to link with old ARM object files or
7094 libraries, which have not been compiled with the -mthumb-interwork
7095 option then the @samp{--support-old-code} command-line switch should be
7096 given to the linker. This will make it generate larger stub functions
7097 which will work with non-interworking aware ARM code. Note, however,
7098 the linker does not support generating stubs for function calls to
7099 non-interworking aware Thumb code.
7100
7101 @cindex thumb entry point
7102 @cindex entry point, thumb
7103 @kindex --thumb-entry=@var{entry}
7104 The @samp{--thumb-entry} switch is a duplicate of the generic
7105 @samp{--entry} switch, in that it sets the program's starting address.
7106 But it also sets the bottom bit of the address, so that it can be
7107 branched to using a BX instruction, and the program will start
7108 executing in Thumb mode straight away.
7109
7110 @cindex PE import table prefixing
7111 @kindex --use-nul-prefixed-import-tables
7112 The @samp{--use-nul-prefixed-import-tables} switch is specifying, that
7113 the import tables idata4 and idata5 have to be generated with a zero
7114 element prefix for import libraries. This is the old style to generate
7115 import tables. By default this option is turned off.
7116
7117 @cindex BE8
7118 @kindex --be8
7119 The @samp{--be8} switch instructs @command{ld} to generate BE8 format
7120 executables. This option is only valid when linking big-endian
7121 objects - ie ones which have been assembled with the @option{-EB}
7122 option. The resulting image will contain big-endian data and
7123 little-endian code.
7124
7125 @cindex TARGET1
7126 @kindex --target1-rel
7127 @kindex --target1-abs
7128 The @samp{R_ARM_TARGET1} relocation is typically used for entries in the
7129 @samp{.init_array} section. It is interpreted as either @samp{R_ARM_REL32}
7130 or @samp{R_ARM_ABS32}, depending on the target. The @samp{--target1-rel}
7131 and @samp{--target1-abs} switches override the default.
7132
7133 @cindex TARGET2
7134 @kindex --target2=@var{type}
7135 The @samp{--target2=type} switch overrides the default definition of the
7136 @samp{R_ARM_TARGET2} relocation. Valid values for @samp{type}, their
7137 meanings, and target defaults are as follows:
7138 @table @samp
7139 @item rel
7140 @samp{R_ARM_REL32} (arm*-*-elf, arm*-*-eabi)
7141 @item abs
7142 @samp{R_ARM_ABS32} (arm*-*-symbianelf)
7143 @item got-rel
7144 @samp{R_ARM_GOT_PREL} (arm*-*-linux, arm*-*-*bsd)
7145 @end table
7146
7147 @cindex FIX_V4BX
7148 @kindex --fix-v4bx
7149 The @samp{R_ARM_V4BX} relocation (defined by the ARM AAELF
7150 specification) enables objects compiled for the ARMv4 architecture to be
7151 interworking-safe when linked with other objects compiled for ARMv4t, but
7152 also allows pure ARMv4 binaries to be built from the same ARMv4 objects.
7153
7154 In the latter case, the switch @option{--fix-v4bx} must be passed to the
7155 linker, which causes v4t @code{BX rM} instructions to be rewritten as
7156 @code{MOV PC,rM}, since v4 processors do not have a @code{BX} instruction.
7157
7158 In the former case, the switch should not be used, and @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7159 relocations are ignored.
7160
7161 @cindex FIX_V4BX_INTERWORKING
7162 @kindex --fix-v4bx-interworking
7163 Replace @code{BX rM} instructions identified by @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7164 relocations with a branch to the following veneer:
7165
7166 @smallexample
7167 TST rM, #1
7168 MOVEQ PC, rM
7169 BX Rn
7170 @end smallexample
7171
7172 This allows generation of libraries/applications that work on ARMv4 cores
7173 and are still interworking safe. Note that the above veneer clobbers the
7174 condition flags, so may cause incorrect program behavior in rare cases.
7175
7176 @cindex USE_BLX
7177 @kindex --use-blx
7178 The @samp{--use-blx} switch enables the linker to use ARM/Thumb
7179 BLX instructions (available on ARMv5t and above) in various
7180 situations. Currently it is used to perform calls via the PLT from Thumb
7181 code using BLX rather than using BX and a mode-switching stub before
7182 each PLT entry. This should lead to such calls executing slightly faster.
7183
7184 This option is enabled implicitly for SymbianOS, so there is no need to
7185 specify it if you are using that target.
7186
7187 @cindex VFP11_DENORM_FIX
7188 @kindex --vfp11-denorm-fix
7189 The @samp{--vfp11-denorm-fix} switch enables a link-time workaround for a
7190 bug in certain VFP11 coprocessor hardware, which sometimes allows
7191 instructions with denorm operands (which must be handled by support code)
7192 to have those operands overwritten by subsequent instructions before
7193 the support code can read the intended values.
7194
7195 The bug may be avoided in scalar mode if you allow at least one
7196 intervening instruction between a VFP11 instruction which uses a register
7197 and another instruction which writes to the same register, or at least two
7198 intervening instructions if vector mode is in use. The bug only affects
7199 full-compliance floating-point mode: you do not need this workaround if
7200 you are using "runfast" mode. Please contact ARM for further details.
7201
7202 If you know you are using buggy VFP11 hardware, you can
7203 enable this workaround by specifying the linker option
7204 @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=scalar} if you are using the VFP11 scalar
7205 mode only, or @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=vector} if you are using
7206 vector mode (the latter also works for scalar code). The default is
7207 @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=none}.
7208
7209 If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7210 potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7211 such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists of the
7212 first instruction of the sequence and a branch back to the subsequent
7213 instruction. The original instruction is then replaced with a branch to
7214 the veneer. The extra cycles required to call and return from the veneer
7215 are sufficient to avoid the erratum in both the scalar and vector cases.
7216
7217 @cindex ARM1176 erratum workaround
7218 @kindex --fix-arm1176
7219 @kindex --no-fix-arm1176
7220 The @samp{--fix-arm1176} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum
7221 in certain ARM1176 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you
7222 are targeting ARM v6 (excluding ARM v6T2) or earlier. It can be disabled
7223 unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-arm1176}.
7224
7225 Further information is available in the ``ARM1176JZ-S and ARM1176JZF-S
7226 Programmer Advice Notice'' available on the ARM documentation website at:
7227 http://infocenter.arm.com/.
7228
7229 @cindex STM32L4xx erratum workaround
7230 @kindex --fix-stm32l4xx-629360
7231
7232 The @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360} switch enables a link-time
7233 workaround for a bug in the bus matrix / memory controller for some of
7234 the STM32 Cortex-M4 based products (STM32L4xx). When accessing
7235 off-chip memory via the affected bus for bus reads of 9 words or more,
7236 the bus can generate corrupt data and/or abort. These are only
7237 core-initiated accesses (not DMA), and might affect any access:
7238 integer loads such as LDM, POP and floating-point loads such as VLDM,
7239 VPOP. Stores are not affected.
7240
7241 The bug can be avoided by splitting memory accesses into the
7242 necessary chunks to keep bus reads below 8 words.
7243
7244 The workaround is not enabled by default, this is equivalent to use
7245 @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=none}. If you know you are using buggy
7246 STM32L4xx hardware, you can enable the workaround by specifying the
7247 linker option @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360}, or the equivalent
7248 @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=default}.
7249
7250 If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7251 potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7252 such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists in a
7253 replacement sequence emulating the behaviour of the original one and a
7254 branch back to the subsequent instruction. The original instruction is
7255 then replaced with a branch to the veneer.
7256
7257 The workaround does not always preserve the memory access order for
7258 the LDMDB instruction, when the instruction loads the PC.
7259
7260 The workaround is not able to handle problematic instructions when
7261 they are in the middle of an IT block, since a branch is not allowed
7262 there. In that case, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7263 occurs.
7264
7265 The workaround is not able to replace problematic instructions with a
7266 PC-relative branch instruction if the @samp{.text} section is too
7267 large. In that case, when the branch that replaces the original code
7268 cannot be encoded, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7269 occurs.
7270
7271 @cindex NO_ENUM_SIZE_WARNING
7272 @kindex --no-enum-size-warning
7273 The @option{--no-enum-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
7274 warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7275 enumeration size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7276 linking of an object file using 32-bit enumeration values with another
7277 using enumeration values fitted into the smallest possible space will
7278 not be diagnosed.
7279
7280 @cindex NO_WCHAR_SIZE_WARNING
7281 @kindex --no-wchar-size-warning
7282 The @option{--no-wchar-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
7283 warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7284 @code{wchar_t} size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7285 linking of an object file using 32-bit @code{wchar_t} values with another
7286 using 16-bit @code{wchar_t} values will not be diagnosed.
7287
7288 @cindex PIC_VENEER
7289 @kindex --pic-veneer
7290 The @samp{--pic-veneer} switch makes the linker use PIC sequences for
7291 ARM/Thumb interworking veneers, even if the rest of the binary
7292 is not PIC. This avoids problems on uClinux targets where
7293 @samp{--emit-relocs} is used to generate relocatable binaries.
7294
7295 @cindex STUB_GROUP_SIZE
7296 @kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7297 The linker will automatically generate and insert small sequences of
7298 code into a linked ARM ELF executable whenever an attempt is made to
7299 perform a function call to a symbol that is too far away. The
7300 placement of these sequences of instructions - called stubs - is
7301 controlled by the command-line option @option{--stub-group-size=N}.
7302 The placement is important because a poor choice can create a need for
7303 duplicate stubs, increasing the code size. The linker will try to
7304 group stubs together in order to reduce interruptions to the flow of
7305 code, but it needs guidance as to how big these groups should be and
7306 where they should be placed.
7307
7308 The value of @samp{N}, the parameter to the
7309 @option{--stub-group-size=} option controls where the stub groups are
7310 placed. If it is negative then all stubs are placed after the first
7311 branch that needs them. If it is positive then the stubs can be
7312 placed either before or after the branches that need them. If the
7313 value of @samp{N} is 1 (either +1 or -1) then the linker will choose
7314 exactly where to place groups of stubs, using its built in heuristics.
7315 A value of @samp{N} greater than 1 (or smaller than -1) tells the
7316 linker that a single group of stubs can service at most @samp{N} bytes
7317 from the input sections.
7318
7319 The default, if @option{--stub-group-size=} is not specified, is
7320 @samp{N = +1}.
7321
7322 Farcalls stubs insertion is fully supported for the ARM-EABI target
7323 only, because it relies on object files properties not present
7324 otherwise.
7325
7326 @cindex Cortex-A8 erratum workaround
7327 @kindex --fix-cortex-a8
7328 @kindex --no-fix-cortex-a8
7329 The @samp{--fix-cortex-a8} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum in certain Cortex-A8 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you are targeting the ARM v7-A architecture profile. It can be enabled otherwise by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a8}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a8}.
7330
7331 The erratum only affects Thumb-2 code. Please contact ARM for further details.
7332
7333 @cindex Cortex-A53 erratum 835769 workaround
7334 @kindex --fix-cortex-a53-835769
7335 @kindex --no-fix-cortex-a53-835769
7336 The @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769} switch enables a link-time workaround for erratum 835769 present on certain early revisions of Cortex-A53 processors. The workaround is disabled by default. It can be enabled by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a53-835769}.
7337
7338 Please contact ARM for further details.
7339
7340 @kindex --merge-exidx-entries
7341 @kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
7342 @cindex Merging exidx entries
7343 The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent exidx entries in debuginfo.
7344
7345 @kindex --long-plt
7346 @cindex 32-bit PLT entries
7347 The @samp{--long-plt} option enables the use of 16 byte PLT entries
7348 which support up to 4Gb of code. The default is to use 12 byte PLT
7349 entries which only support 512Mb of code.
7350
7351 @kindex --no-apply-dynamic-relocs
7352 @cindex AArch64 rela addend
7353 The @samp{--no-apply-dynamic-relocs} option makes AArch64 linker do not apply
7354 link-time values for dynamic relocations.
7355
7356 @cindex Placement of SG veneers
7357 All SG veneers are placed in the special output section @code{.gnu.sgstubs}.
7358 Its start address must be set, either with the command-line option
7359 @samp{--section-start} or in a linker script, to indicate where to place these
7360 veneers in memory.
7361
7362 @kindex --cmse-implib
7363 @cindex Secure gateway import library
7364 The @samp{--cmse-implib} option requests that the import libraries
7365 specified by the @samp{--out-implib} and @samp{--in-implib} options are
7366 secure gateway import libraries, suitable for linking a non-secure
7367 executable against secure code as per ARMv8-M Security Extensions.
7368
7369 @kindex --in-implib=@var{file}
7370 @cindex Input import library
7371 The @samp{--in-implib=file} specifies an input import library whose symbols
7372 must keep the same address in the executable being produced. A warning is
7373 given if no @samp{--out-implib} is given but new symbols have been introduced
7374 in the executable that should be listed in its import library. Otherwise, if
7375 @samp{--out-implib} is specified, the symbols are added to the output import
7376 library. A warning is also given if some symbols present in the input import
7377 library have disappeared from the executable. This option is only effective
7378 for Secure Gateway import libraries, ie. when @samp{--cmse-implib} is
7379 specified.
7380
7381 @ifclear GENERIC
7382 @lowersections
7383 @end ifclear
7384 @end ifset
7385
7386 @ifset HPPA
7387 @ifclear GENERIC
7388 @raisesections
7389 @end ifclear
7390
7391 @node HPPA ELF32
7392 @section @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF Support
7393 @cindex HPPA multiple sub-space stubs
7394 @kindex --multi-subspace
7395 When generating a shared library, @command{ld} will by default generate
7396 import stubs suitable for use with a single sub-space application.
7397 The @samp{--multi-subspace} switch causes @command{ld} to generate export
7398 stubs, and different (larger) import stubs suitable for use with
7399 multiple sub-spaces.
7400
7401 @cindex HPPA stub grouping
7402 @kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7403 Long branch stubs and import/export stubs are placed by @command{ld} in
7404 stub sections located between groups of input sections.
7405 @samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
7406 sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
7407 a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
7408 the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
7409 conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
7410 prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
7411 A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
7412 branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
7413 @samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
7414 @command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
7415 detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
7416 positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
7417
7418 Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
7419 single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
7420 create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
7421 large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
7422
7423 @ifclear GENERIC
7424 @lowersections
7425 @end ifclear
7426 @end ifset
7427
7428 @ifset M68K
7429 @ifclear GENERIC
7430 @raisesections
7431 @end ifclear
7432
7433 @node M68K
7434 @section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7435
7436 @cindex Motorola 68K GOT generation
7437 @kindex --got=@var{type}
7438 The @samp{--got=@var{type}} option lets you choose the GOT generation scheme.
7439 The choices are @samp{single}, @samp{negative}, @samp{multigot} and
7440 @samp{target}. When @samp{target} is selected the linker chooses
7441 the default GOT generation scheme for the current target.
7442 @samp{single} tells the linker to generate a single GOT with
7443 entries only at non-negative offsets.
7444 @samp{negative} instructs the linker to generate a single GOT with
7445 entries at both negative and positive offsets. Not all environments
7446 support such GOTs.
7447 @samp{multigot} allows the linker to generate several GOTs in the
7448 output file. All GOT references from a single input object
7449 file access the same GOT, but references from different input object
7450 files might access different GOTs. Not all environments support such GOTs.
7451
7452 @ifclear GENERIC
7453 @lowersections
7454 @end ifclear
7455 @end ifset
7456
7457 @ifset MIPS
7458 @ifclear GENERIC
7459 @raisesections
7460 @end ifclear
7461
7462 @node MIPS
7463 @section @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7464
7465 @cindex MIPS microMIPS instruction choice selection
7466 @kindex --insn32
7467 @kindex --no-insn32
7468 The @samp{--insn32} and @samp{--no-insn32} options control the choice of
7469 microMIPS instructions used in code generated by the linker, such as that
7470 in the PLT or lazy binding stubs, or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is
7471 used, then the linker only uses 32-bit instruction encodings. By default
7472 or if @samp{--no-insn32} is used, all instruction encodings are used,
7473 including 16-bit ones where possible.
7474
7475 @cindex MIPS branch relocation check control
7476 @kindex --ignore-branch-isa
7477 @kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
7478 The @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} and @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} options
7479 control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode transitions. If
7480 @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker accepts any branch
7481 relocations and any ISA mode transition required is lost in relocation
7482 calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL} instructions which meet
7483 relaxation conditions and are converted to equivalent @code{JALX}
7484 instructions as the associated relocation is calculated. By default
7485 or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used a check is made causing
7486 the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce an error.
7487
7488 @ifclear GENERIC
7489 @lowersections
7490 @end ifclear
7491 @end ifset
7492
7493 @ifset MMIX
7494 @ifclear GENERIC
7495 @raisesections
7496 @end ifclear
7497
7498 @node MMIX
7499 @section @code{ld} and MMIX
7500 For MMIX, there is a choice of generating @code{ELF} object files or
7501 @code{mmo} object files when linking. The simulator @code{mmix}
7502 understands the @code{mmo} format. The binutils @code{objcopy} utility
7503 can translate between the two formats.
7504
7505 There is one special section, the @samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section.
7506 Contents in this section is assumed to correspond to that of global
7507 registers, and symbols referring to it are translated to special symbols,
7508 equal to registers. In a final link, the start address of the
7509 @samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section corresponds to the first allocated
7510 global register multiplied by 8. Register @code{$255} is not included in
7511 this section; it is always set to the program entry, which is at the
7512 symbol @code{Main} for @code{mmo} files.
7513
7514 Global symbols with the prefix @code{__.MMIX.start.}, for example
7515 @code{__.MMIX.start..text} and @code{__.MMIX.start..data} are special.
7516 The default linker script uses these to set the default start address
7517 of a section.
7518
7519 Initial and trailing multiples of zero-valued 32-bit words in a section,
7520 are left out from an mmo file.
7521
7522 @ifclear GENERIC
7523 @lowersections
7524 @end ifclear
7525 @end ifset
7526
7527 @ifset MSP430
7528 @ifclear GENERIC
7529 @raisesections
7530 @end ifclear
7531
7532 @node MSP430
7533 @section @code{ld} and MSP430
7534 For the MSP430 it is possible to select the MPU architecture. The flag @samp{-m [mpu type]}
7535 will select an appropriate linker script for selected MPU type. (To get a list of known MPUs
7536 just pass @samp{-m help} option to the linker).
7537
7538 @cindex MSP430 extra sections
7539 The linker will recognize some extra sections which are MSP430 specific:
7540
7541 @table @code
7542 @item @samp{.vectors}
7543 Defines a portion of ROM where interrupt vectors located.
7544
7545 @item @samp{.bootloader}
7546 Defines the bootloader portion of the ROM (if applicable). Any code
7547 in this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7548
7549 @item @samp{.infomem}
7550 Defines an information memory section (if applicable). Any code in
7551 this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7552
7553 @item @samp{.infomemnobits}
7554 This is the same as the @samp{.infomem} section except that any code
7555 in this section will not be uploaded to the MPU.
7556
7557 @item @samp{.noinit}
7558 Denotes a portion of RAM located above @samp{.bss} section.
7559
7560 The last two sections are used by gcc.
7561 @end table
7562
7563 @table @option
7564 @cindex MSP430 Options
7565 @kindex --code-region
7566 @item --code-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7567 This will transform .text* sections to [either,lower,upper].text* sections. The
7568 argument passed to GCC for -mcode-region is propagated to the linker
7569 using this option.
7570
7571 @kindex --data-region
7572 @item --data-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7573 This will transform .data*, .bss* and .rodata* sections to
7574 [either,lower,upper].[data,bss,rodata]* sections. The argument passed to GCC
7575 for -mdata-region is propagated to the linker using this option.
7576
7577 @kindex --disable-sec-transformation
7578 @item --disable-sec-transformation
7579 Prevent the transformation of sections as specified by the @code{--code-region}
7580 and @code{--data-region} options.
7581 This is useful if you are compiling and linking using a single call to the GCC
7582 wrapper, and want to compile the source files using -m[code,data]-region but
7583 not transform the sections for prebuilt libraries and objects.
7584 @end table
7585
7586 @ifclear GENERIC
7587 @lowersections
7588 @end ifclear
7589 @end ifset
7590
7591 @ifset NDS32
7592 @ifclear GENERIC
7593 @raisesections
7594 @end ifclear
7595
7596 @node NDS32
7597 @section @code{ld} and NDS32
7598 @kindex relaxing on NDS32
7599 For NDS32, there are some options to select relaxation behavior. The linker
7600 relaxes objects according to these options.
7601
7602 @table @code
7603 @item @samp{--m[no-]fp-as-gp}
7604 Disable/enable fp-as-gp relaxation.
7605
7606 @item @samp{--mexport-symbols=FILE}
7607 Exporting symbols and their address into FILE as linker script.
7608
7609 @item @samp{--m[no-]ex9}
7610 Disable/enable link-time EX9 relaxation.
7611
7612 @item @samp{--mexport-ex9=FILE}
7613 Export the EX9 table after linking.
7614
7615 @item @samp{--mimport-ex9=FILE}
7616 Import the Ex9 table for EX9 relaxation.
7617
7618 @item @samp{--mupdate-ex9}
7619 Update the existing EX9 table.
7620
7621 @item @samp{--mex9-limit=NUM}
7622 Maximum number of entries in the ex9 table.
7623
7624 @item @samp{--mex9-loop-aware}
7625 Avoid generating the EX9 instruction inside the loop.
7626
7627 @item @samp{--m[no-]ifc}
7628 Disable/enable the link-time IFC optimization.
7629
7630 @item @samp{--mifc-loop-aware}
7631 Avoid generating the IFC instruction inside the loop.
7632 @end table
7633
7634 @ifclear GENERIC
7635 @lowersections
7636 @end ifclear
7637 @end ifset
7638
7639 @ifset NIOSII
7640 @ifclear GENERIC
7641 @raisesections
7642 @end ifclear
7643
7644 @node Nios II
7645 @section @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
7646 @cindex Nios II call relaxation
7647 @kindex --relax on Nios II
7648
7649 Call and immediate jump instructions on Nios II processors are limited to
7650 transferring control to addresses in the same 256MB memory segment,
7651 which may result in @command{ld} giving
7652 @samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
7653 The command-line option @option{--relax} enables the generation of
7654 trampolines that can access the entire 32-bit address space for calls
7655 outside the normal @code{call} and @code{jmpi} address range. These
7656 trampolines are inserted at section boundaries, so may not themselves
7657 be reachable if an input section and its associated call trampolines are
7658 larger than 256MB.
7659
7660 The @option{--relax} option is enabled by default unless @option{-r}
7661 is also specified. You can disable trampoline generation by using the
7662 @option{--no-relax} linker option. You can also disable this optimization
7663 locally by using the @samp{set .noat} directive in assembly-language
7664 source files, as the linker-inserted trampolines use the @code{at}
7665 register as a temporary.
7666
7667 Note that the linker @option{--relax} option is independent of assembler
7668 relaxation options, and that using the GNU assembler's @option{-relax-all}
7669 option interferes with the linker's more selective call instruction relaxation.
7670
7671 @ifclear GENERIC
7672 @lowersections
7673 @end ifclear
7674 @end ifset
7675
7676 @ifset POWERPC
7677 @ifclear GENERIC
7678 @raisesections
7679 @end ifclear
7680
7681 @node PowerPC ELF32
7682 @section @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
7683 @cindex PowerPC long branches
7684 @kindex --relax on PowerPC
7685 Branches on PowerPC processors are limited to a signed 26-bit
7686 displacement, which may result in @command{ld} giving
7687 @samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
7688 @samp{--relax} enables the generation of trampolines that can access
7689 the entire 32-bit address space. These trampolines are inserted at
7690 section boundaries, so may not themselves be reachable if an input
7691 section exceeds 33M in size. You may combine @samp{-r} and
7692 @samp{--relax} to add trampolines in a partial link. In that case
7693 both branches to undefined symbols and inter-section branches are also
7694 considered potentially out of range, and trampolines inserted.
7695
7696 @cindex PowerPC ELF32 options
7697 @table @option
7698 @cindex PowerPC PLT
7699 @kindex --bss-plt
7700 @item --bss-plt
7701 Current PowerPC GCC accepts a @samp{-msecure-plt} option that
7702 generates code capable of using a newer PLT and GOT layout that has
7703 the security advantage of no executable section ever needing to be
7704 writable and no writable section ever being executable. PowerPC
7705 @command{ld} will generate this layout, including stubs to access the
7706 PLT, if all input files (including startup and static libraries) were
7707 compiled with @samp{-msecure-plt}. @samp{--bss-plt} forces the old
7708 BSS PLT (and GOT layout) which can give slightly better performance.
7709
7710 @kindex --secure-plt
7711 @item --secure-plt
7712 @command{ld} will use the new PLT and GOT layout if it is linking new
7713 @samp{-fpic} or @samp{-fPIC} code, but does not do so automatically
7714 when linking non-PIC code. This option requests the new PLT and GOT
7715 layout. A warning will be given if some object file requires the old
7716 style BSS PLT.
7717
7718 @cindex PowerPC GOT
7719 @kindex --sdata-got
7720 @item --sdata-got
7721 The new secure PLT and GOT are placed differently relative to other
7722 sections compared to older BSS PLT and GOT placement. The location of
7723 @code{.plt} must change because the new secure PLT is an initialized
7724 section while the old PLT is uninitialized. The reason for the
7725 @code{.got} change is more subtle: The new placement allows
7726 @code{.got} to be read-only in applications linked with
7727 @samp{-z relro -z now}. However, this placement means that
7728 @code{.sdata} cannot always be used in shared libraries, because the
7729 PowerPC ABI accesses @code{.sdata} in shared libraries from the GOT
7730 pointer. @samp{--sdata-got} forces the old GOT placement. PowerPC
7731 GCC doesn't use @code{.sdata} in shared libraries, so this option is
7732 really only useful for other compilers that may do so.
7733
7734 @cindex PowerPC stub symbols
7735 @kindex --emit-stub-syms
7736 @item --emit-stub-syms
7737 This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
7738 symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
7739
7740 @cindex PowerPC TLS optimization
7741 @kindex --no-tls-optimize
7742 @item --no-tls-optimize
7743 PowerPC @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
7744 sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
7745 disable the optimization.
7746 @end table
7747
7748 @ifclear GENERIC
7749 @lowersections
7750 @end ifclear
7751 @end ifset
7752
7753 @ifset POWERPC64
7754 @ifclear GENERIC
7755 @raisesections
7756 @end ifclear
7757
7758 @node PowerPC64 ELF64
7759 @section @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
7760
7761 @cindex PowerPC64 ELF64 options
7762 @table @option
7763 @cindex PowerPC64 stub grouping
7764 @kindex --stub-group-size
7765 @item --stub-group-size
7766 Long branch stubs, PLT call stubs and TOC adjusting stubs are placed
7767 by @command{ld} in stub sections located between groups of input sections.
7768 @samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
7769 sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
7770 a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
7771 the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
7772 conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
7773 prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
7774 A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
7775 branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
7776 @samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
7777 @command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
7778 detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
7779 positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
7780
7781 Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
7782 single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
7783 create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
7784 large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
7785
7786 @cindex PowerPC64 stub symbols
7787 @kindex --emit-stub-syms
7788 @item --emit-stub-syms
7789 This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
7790 symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
7791
7792 @cindex PowerPC64 dot symbols
7793 @kindex --dotsyms
7794 @kindex --no-dotsyms
7795 @item --dotsyms
7796 @itemx --no-dotsyms
7797 These two options control how @command{ld} interprets version patterns
7798 in a version script. Older PowerPC64 compilers emitted both a
7799 function descriptor symbol with the same name as the function, and a
7800 code entry symbol with the name prefixed by a dot (@samp{.}). To
7801 properly version a function @samp{foo}, the version script thus needs
7802 to control both @samp{foo} and @samp{.foo}. The option
7803 @samp{--dotsyms}, on by default, automatically adds the required
7804 dot-prefixed patterns. Use @samp{--no-dotsyms} to disable this
7805 feature.
7806
7807 @cindex PowerPC64 register save/restore functions
7808 @kindex --save-restore-funcs
7809 @kindex --no-save-restore-funcs
7810 @item --save-restore-funcs
7811 @itemx --no-save-restore-funcs
7812 These two options control whether PowerPC64 @command{ld} automatically
7813 provides out-of-line register save and restore functions used by
7814 @samp{-Os} code. The default is to provide any such referenced
7815 function for a normal final link, and to not do so for a relocatable
7816 link.
7817
7818 @cindex PowerPC64 TLS optimization
7819 @kindex --no-tls-optimize
7820 @item --no-tls-optimize
7821 PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
7822 sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
7823 disable the optimization.
7824
7825 @cindex PowerPC64 __tls_get_addr optimization
7826 @kindex --tls-get-addr-optimize
7827 @kindex --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
7828 @kindex --tls-get-addr-regsave
7829 @kindex --no-tls-get-addr-regsave
7830 @item --tls-get-addr-optimize
7831 @itemx --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
7832 These options control how PowerPC64 @command{ld} uses a special
7833 stub to call __tls_get_addr. PowerPC64 glibc 2.22 and later support
7834 an optimization that allows the second and subsequent calls to
7835 @code{__tls_get_addr} for a given symbol to be resolved by the special
7836 stub without calling in to glibc. By default the linker enables
7837 generation of the stub when glibc advertises the availability of
7838 __tls_get_addr_opt.
7839 Using @option{--tls-get-addr-optimize} with an older glibc won't do
7840 much besides slow down your applications, but may be useful if linking
7841 an application against an older glibc with the expectation that it
7842 will normally be used on systems having a newer glibc.
7843 @option{--tls-get-addr-regsave} forces generation of a stub that saves
7844 and restores volatile registers around the call into glibc. Normally,
7845 this is done when the linker detects a call to __tls_get_addr_desc.
7846 Such calls then go via the register saving stub to __tls_get_addr_opt.
7847 @option{--no-tls-get-addr-regsave} disables generation of the
7848 register saves.
7849
7850 @cindex PowerPC64 OPD optimization
7851 @kindex --no-opd-optimize
7852 @item --no-opd-optimize
7853 PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes @code{.opd} section entries
7854 corresponding to deleted link-once functions, or functions removed by
7855 the action of @samp{--gc-sections} or linker script @code{/DISCARD/}.
7856 Use this option to disable @code{.opd} optimization.
7857
7858 @cindex PowerPC64 OPD spacing
7859 @kindex --non-overlapping-opd
7860 @item --non-overlapping-opd
7861 Some PowerPC64 compilers have an option to generate compressed
7862 @code{.opd} entries spaced 16 bytes apart, overlapping the third word,
7863 the static chain pointer (unused in C) with the first word of the next
7864 entry. This option expands such entries to the full 24 bytes.
7865
7866 @cindex PowerPC64 TOC optimization
7867 @kindex --no-toc-optimize
7868 @item --no-toc-optimize
7869 PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes unused @code{.toc} section
7870 entries. Such entries are detected by examining relocations that
7871 reference the TOC in code sections. A reloc in a deleted code section
7872 marks a TOC word as unneeded, while a reloc in a kept code section
7873 marks a TOC word as needed. Since the TOC may reference itself, TOC
7874 relocs are also examined. TOC words marked as both needed and
7875 unneeded will of course be kept. TOC words without any referencing
7876 reloc are assumed to be part of a multi-word entry, and are kept or
7877 discarded as per the nearest marked preceding word. This works
7878 reliably for compiler generated code, but may be incorrect if assembly
7879 code is used to insert TOC entries. Use this option to disable the
7880 optimization.
7881
7882 @cindex PowerPC64 inline PLT call optimization
7883 @kindex --no-inline-optimize
7884 @item --no-inline-optimize
7885 PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally replaces inline PLT call sequences
7886 marked with @code{R_PPC64_PLTSEQ}, @code{R_PPC64_PLTCALL},
7887 @code{R_PPC64_PLT16_HA} and @code{R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS} relocations by
7888 a number of @code{nop}s and a direct call when the function is defined
7889 locally and can't be overridden by some other definition. This option
7890 disables that optimization.
7891
7892 @cindex PowerPC64 multi-TOC
7893 @kindex --no-multi-toc
7894 @item --no-multi-toc
7895 If given any toc option besides @code{-mcmodel=medium} or
7896 @code{-mcmodel=large}, PowerPC64 GCC generates code for a TOC model
7897 where TOC
7898 entries are accessed with a 16-bit offset from r2. This limits the
7899 total TOC size to 64K. PowerPC64 @command{ld} extends this limit by
7900 grouping code sections such that each group uses less than 64K for its
7901 TOC entries, then inserts r2 adjusting stubs between inter-group
7902 calls. @command{ld} does not split apart input sections, so cannot
7903 help if a single input file has a @code{.toc} section that exceeds
7904 64K, most likely from linking multiple files with @command{ld -r}.
7905 Use this option to turn off this feature.
7906
7907 @cindex PowerPC64 TOC sorting
7908 @kindex --no-toc-sort
7909 @item --no-toc-sort
7910 By default, @command{ld} sorts TOC sections so that those whose file
7911 happens to have a section called @code{.init} or @code{.fini} are
7912 placed first, followed by TOC sections referenced by code generated
7913 with PowerPC64 gcc's @code{-mcmodel=small}, and lastly TOC sections
7914 referenced only by code generated with PowerPC64 gcc's
7915 @code{-mcmodel=medium} or @code{-mcmodel=large} options. Doing this
7916 results in better TOC grouping for multi-TOC. Use this option to turn
7917 off this feature.
7918
7919 @cindex PowerPC64 PLT stub alignment
7920 @kindex --plt-align
7921 @kindex --no-plt-align
7922 @item --plt-align
7923 @itemx --no-plt-align
7924 Use these options to control whether individual PLT call stubs are
7925 aligned to a 32-byte boundary, or to the specified power of two
7926 boundary when using @code{--plt-align=}. A negative value may be
7927 specified to pad PLT call stubs so that they do not cross the
7928 specified power of two boundary (or the minimum number of boundaries
7929 if a PLT stub is so large that it must cross a boundary). By default
7930 PLT call stubs are aligned to 32-byte boundaries.
7931
7932 @cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub static chain
7933 @kindex --plt-static-chain
7934 @kindex --no-plt-static-chain
7935 @item --plt-static-chain
7936 @itemx --no-plt-static-chain
7937 Use these options to control whether PLT call stubs load the static
7938 chain pointer (r11). @code{ld} defaults to not loading the static
7939 chain since there is never any need to do so on a PLT call.
7940
7941 @cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub thread safety
7942 @kindex --plt-thread-safe
7943 @kindex --no-plt-thread-safe
7944 @item --plt-thread-safe
7945 @itemx --no-plt-thread-safe
7946 With power7's weakly ordered memory model, it is possible when using
7947 lazy binding for ld.so to update a plt entry in one thread and have
7948 another thread see the individual plt entry words update in the wrong
7949 order, despite ld.so carefully writing in the correct order and using
7950 memory write barriers. To avoid this we need some sort of read
7951 barrier in the call stub, or use LD_BIND_NOW=1. By default, @code{ld}
7952 looks for calls to commonly used functions that create threads, and if
7953 seen, adds the necessary barriers. Use these options to change the
7954 default behaviour.
7955
7956 @cindex PowerPC64 ELFv2 PLT localentry optimization
7957 @kindex --plt-localentry
7958 @kindex --no-plt-localentry
7959 @item --plt-localentry
7960 @itemx --no-localentry
7961 ELFv2 functions with localentry:0 are those with a single entry point,
7962 ie. global entry == local entry, and that have no requirement on r2
7963 (the TOC/GOT pointer) or r12, and guarantee r2 is unchanged on return.
7964 Such an external function can be called via the PLT without saving r2
7965 or restoring it on return, avoiding a common load-hit-store for small
7966 functions. The optimization is attractive, with up to 40% reduction
7967 in execution time for a small function, but can result in symbol
7968 interposition failures. Also, minor changes in a shared library,
7969 including system libraries, can cause a function that was localentry:0
7970 to become localentry:8. This will result in a dynamic loader
7971 complaint and failure to run. The option is experimental, use with
7972 care. @option{--no-plt-localentry} is the default.
7973
7974 @cindex PowerPC64 Power10 stubs
7975 @kindex --power10-stubs
7976 @kindex --no-power10-stubs
7977 @item --power10-stubs
7978 @itemx --no-power10-stubs
7979 When PowerPC64 @command{ld} links input object files containing
7980 relocations used on power10 prefixed instructions it normally creates
7981 linkage stubs (PLT call and long branch) using power10 instructions
7982 for @code{@@notoc} PLT calls where @code{r2} is not known. The
7983 power10 notoc stubs are smaller and faster, so are preferred for
7984 power10. @option{--power10-stubs} and @option{--no-power10-stubs}
7985 allow you to override the linker's selection of stub instructions.
7986 @option{--power10-stubs=auto} allows the user to select the default
7987 auto mode.
7988 @end table
7989
7990 @ifclear GENERIC
7991 @lowersections
7992 @end ifclear
7993 @end ifset
7994
7995 @ifset S/390
7996 @ifclear GENERIC
7997 @raisesections
7998 @end ifclear
7999
8000 @node S/390 ELF
8001 @section @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
8002
8003 @cindex S/390 ELF options
8004 @table @option
8005
8006 @cindex S/390
8007 @kindex --s390-pgste
8008 @item --s390-pgste
8009 This option marks the result file with a @code{PT_S390_PGSTE}
8010 segment. The Linux kernel is supposed to allocate 4k page tables for
8011 binaries marked that way.
8012 @end table
8013
8014 @ifclear GENERIC
8015 @lowersections
8016 @end ifclear
8017 @end ifset
8018
8019 @ifset SPU
8020 @ifclear GENERIC
8021 @raisesections
8022 @end ifclear
8023
8024 @node SPU ELF
8025 @section @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
8026
8027 @cindex SPU ELF options
8028 @table @option
8029
8030 @cindex SPU plugins
8031 @kindex --plugin
8032 @item --plugin
8033 This option marks an executable as a PIC plugin module.
8034
8035 @cindex SPU overlays
8036 @kindex --no-overlays
8037 @item --no-overlays
8038 Normally, @command{ld} recognizes calls to functions within overlay
8039 regions, and redirects such calls to an overlay manager via a stub.
8040 @command{ld} also provides a built-in overlay manager. This option
8041 turns off all this special overlay handling.
8042
8043 @cindex SPU overlay stub symbols
8044 @kindex --emit-stub-syms
8045 @item --emit-stub-syms
8046 This option causes @command{ld} to label overlay stubs with a local
8047 symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8048
8049 @cindex SPU extra overlay stubs
8050 @kindex --extra-overlay-stubs
8051 @item --extra-overlay-stubs
8052 This option causes @command{ld} to add overlay call stubs on all
8053 function calls out of overlay regions. Normally stubs are not added
8054 on calls to non-overlay regions.
8055
8056 @cindex SPU local store size
8057 @kindex --local-store=lo:hi
8058 @item --local-store=lo:hi
8059 @command{ld} usually checks that a final executable for SPU fits in
8060 the address range 0 to 256k. This option may be used to change the
8061 range. Disable the check entirely with @option{--local-store=0:0}.
8062
8063 @cindex SPU
8064 @kindex --stack-analysis
8065 @item --stack-analysis
8066 SPU local store space is limited. Over-allocation of stack space
8067 unnecessarily limits space available for code and data, while
8068 under-allocation results in runtime failures. If given this option,
8069 @command{ld} will provide an estimate of maximum stack usage.
8070 @command{ld} does this by examining symbols in code sections to
8071 determine the extents of functions, and looking at function prologues
8072 for stack adjusting instructions. A call-graph is created by looking
8073 for relocations on branch instructions. The graph is then searched
8074 for the maximum stack usage path. Note that this analysis does not
8075 find calls made via function pointers, and does not handle recursion
8076 and other cycles in the call graph. Stack usage may be
8077 under-estimated if your code makes such calls. Also, stack usage for
8078 dynamic allocation, e.g. alloca, will not be detected. If a link map
8079 is requested, detailed information about each function's stack usage
8080 and calls will be given.
8081
8082 @cindex SPU
8083 @kindex --emit-stack-syms
8084 @item --emit-stack-syms
8085 This option, if given along with @option{--stack-analysis} will result
8086 in @command{ld} emitting stack sizing symbols for each function.
8087 These take the form @code{__stack_<function_name>} for global
8088 functions, and @code{__stack_<number>_<function_name>} for static
8089 functions. @code{<number>} is the section id in hex. The value of
8090 such symbols is the stack requirement for the corresponding function.
8091 The symbol size will be zero, type @code{STT_NOTYPE}, binding
8092 @code{STB_LOCAL}, and section @code{SHN_ABS}.
8093 @end table
8094
8095 @ifclear GENERIC
8096 @lowersections
8097 @end ifclear
8098 @end ifset
8099
8100 @ifset TICOFF
8101 @ifclear GENERIC
8102 @raisesections
8103 @end ifclear
8104
8105 @node TI COFF
8106 @section @command{ld}'s Support for Various TI COFF Versions
8107 @cindex TI COFF versions
8108 @kindex --format=@var{version}
8109 The @samp{--format} switch allows selection of one of the various
8110 TI COFF versions. The latest of this writing is 2; versions 0 and 1 are
8111 also supported. The TI COFF versions also vary in header byte-order
8112 format; @command{ld} will read any version or byte order, but the output
8113 header format depends on the default specified by the specific target.
8114
8115 @ifclear GENERIC
8116 @lowersections
8117 @end ifclear
8118 @end ifset
8119
8120 @ifset WIN32
8121 @ifclear GENERIC
8122 @raisesections
8123 @end ifclear
8124
8125 @node WIN32
8126 @section @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
8127
8128 This section describes some of the win32 specific @command{ld} issues.
8129 See @ref{Options,,Command-line Options} for detailed description of the
8130 command-line options mentioned here.
8131
8132 @table @emph
8133 @cindex import libraries
8134 @item import libraries
8135 The standard Windows linker creates and uses so-called import
8136 libraries, which contains information for linking to dll's. They are
8137 regular static archives and are handled as any other static
8138 archive. The cygwin and mingw ports of @command{ld} have specific
8139 support for creating such libraries provided with the
8140 @samp{--out-implib} command-line option.
8141
8142 @item exporting DLL symbols
8143 @cindex exporting DLL symbols
8144 The cygwin/mingw @command{ld} has several ways to export symbols for dll's.
8145
8146 @table @emph
8147 @item using auto-export functionality
8148 @cindex using auto-export functionality
8149 By default @command{ld} exports symbols with the auto-export functionality,
8150 which is controlled by the following command-line options:
8151
8152 @itemize
8153 @item --export-all-symbols [This is the default]
8154 @item --exclude-symbols
8155 @item --exclude-libs
8156 @item --exclude-modules-for-implib
8157 @item --version-script
8158 @end itemize
8159
8160 When auto-export is in operation, @command{ld} will export all the non-local
8161 (global and common) symbols it finds in a DLL, with the exception of a few
8162 symbols known to belong to the system's runtime and libraries. As it will
8163 often not be desirable to export all of a DLL's symbols, which may include
8164 private functions that are not part of any public interface, the command-line
8165 options listed above may be used to filter symbols out from the list for
8166 exporting. The @samp{--output-def} option can be used in order to see the
8167 final list of exported symbols with all exclusions taken into effect.
8168
8169 If @samp{--export-all-symbols} is not given explicitly on the
8170 command line, then the default auto-export behavior will be @emph{disabled}
8171 if either of the following are true:
8172
8173 @itemize
8174 @item A DEF file is used.
8175 @item Any symbol in any object file was marked with the __declspec(dllexport) attribute.
8176 @end itemize
8177
8178 @item using a DEF file
8179 @cindex using a DEF file
8180 Another way of exporting symbols is using a DEF file. A DEF file is
8181 an ASCII file containing definitions of symbols which should be
8182 exported when a dll is created. Usually it is named @samp{<dll
8183 name>.def} and is added as any other object file to the linker's
8184 command line. The file's name must end in @samp{.def} or @samp{.DEF}.
8185
8186 @example
8187 gcc -o <output> <objectfiles> <dll name>.def
8188 @end example
8189
8190 Using a DEF file turns off the normal auto-export behavior, unless the
8191 @samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8192
8193 Here is an example of a DEF file for a shared library called @samp{xyz.dll}:
8194
8195 @example
8196 LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x20000000
8197
8198 EXPORTS
8199 foo
8200 bar
8201 _bar = bar
8202 another_foo = abc.dll.afoo
8203 var1 DATA
8204 doo = foo == foo2
8205 eoo DATA == var1
8206 @end example
8207
8208 This example defines a DLL with a non-default base address and seven
8209 symbols in the export table. The third exported symbol @code{_bar} is an
8210 alias for the second. The fourth symbol, @code{another_foo} is resolved
8211 by "forwarding" to another module and treating it as an alias for
8212 @code{afoo} exported from the DLL @samp{abc.dll}. The final symbol
8213 @code{var1} is declared to be a data object. The @samp{doo} symbol in
8214 export library is an alias of @samp{foo}, which gets the string name
8215 in export table @samp{foo2}. The @samp{eoo} symbol is an data export
8216 symbol, which gets in export table the name @samp{var1}.
8217
8218 The optional @code{LIBRARY <name>} command indicates the @emph{internal}
8219 name of the output DLL. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix,
8220 the default library suffix, @samp{.DLL} is appended.
8221
8222 When the .DEF file is used to build an application, rather than a
8223 library, the @code{NAME <name>} command should be used instead of
8224 @code{LIBRARY}. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix, the default
8225 executable suffix, @samp{.EXE} is appended.
8226
8227 With either @code{LIBRARY <name>} or @code{NAME <name>} the optional
8228 specification @code{BASE = <number>} may be used to specify a
8229 non-default base address for the image.
8230
8231 If neither @code{LIBRARY <name>} nor @code{NAME <name>} is specified,
8232 or they specify an empty string, the internal name is the same as the
8233 filename specified on the command line.
8234
8235 The complete specification of an export symbol is:
8236
8237 @example
8238 EXPORTS
8239 ( ( ( <name1> [ = <name2> ] )
8240 | ( <name1> = <module-name> . <external-name>))
8241 [ @@ <integer> ] [NONAME] [DATA] [CONSTANT] [PRIVATE] [== <name3>] ) *
8242 @end example
8243
8244 Declares @samp{<name1>} as an exported symbol from the DLL, or declares
8245 @samp{<name1>} as an exported alias for @samp{<name2>}; or declares
8246 @samp{<name1>} as a "forward" alias for the symbol
8247 @samp{<external-name>} in the DLL @samp{<module-name>}.
8248 Optionally, the symbol may be exported by the specified ordinal
8249 @samp{<integer>} alias. The optional @samp{<name3>} is the to be used
8250 string in import/export table for the symbol.
8251
8252 The optional keywords that follow the declaration indicate:
8253
8254 @code{NONAME}: Do not put the symbol name in the DLL's export table. It
8255 will still be exported by its ordinal alias (either the value specified
8256 by the .def specification or, otherwise, the value assigned by the
8257 linker). The symbol name, however, does remain visible in the import
8258 library (if any), unless @code{PRIVATE} is also specified.
8259
8260 @code{DATA}: The symbol is a variable or object, rather than a function.
8261 The import lib will export only an indirect reference to @code{foo} as
8262 the symbol @code{_imp__foo} (ie, @code{foo} must be resolved as
8263 @code{*_imp__foo}).
8264
8265 @code{CONSTANT}: Like @code{DATA}, but put the undecorated @code{foo} as
8266 well as @code{_imp__foo} into the import library. Both refer to the
8267 read-only import address table's pointer to the variable, not to the
8268 variable itself. This can be dangerous. If the user code fails to add
8269 the @code{dllimport} attribute and also fails to explicitly add the
8270 extra indirection that the use of the attribute enforces, the
8271 application will behave unexpectedly.
8272
8273 @code{PRIVATE}: Put the symbol in the DLL's export table, but do not put
8274 it into the static import library used to resolve imports at link time. The
8275 symbol can still be imported using the @code{LoadLibrary/GetProcAddress}
8276 API at runtime or by using the GNU ld extension of linking directly to
8277 the DLL without an import library.
8278
8279 See ld/deffilep.y in the binutils sources for the full specification of
8280 other DEF file statements
8281
8282 @cindex creating a DEF file
8283 While linking a shared dll, @command{ld} is able to create a DEF file
8284 with the @samp{--output-def <file>} command-line option.
8285
8286 @item Using decorations
8287 @cindex Using decorations
8288 Another way of marking symbols for export is to modify the source code
8289 itself, so that when building the DLL each symbol to be exported is
8290 declared as:
8291
8292 @example
8293 __declspec(dllexport) int a_variable
8294 __declspec(dllexport) void a_function(int with_args)
8295 @end example
8296
8297 All such symbols will be exported from the DLL. If, however,
8298 any of the object files in the DLL contain symbols decorated in
8299 this way, then the normal auto-export behavior is disabled, unless
8300 the @samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8301
8302 Note that object files that wish to access these symbols must @emph{not}
8303 decorate them with dllexport. Instead, they should use dllimport,
8304 instead:
8305
8306 @example
8307 __declspec(dllimport) int a_variable
8308 __declspec(dllimport) void a_function(int with_args)
8309 @end example
8310
8311 This complicates the structure of library header files, because
8312 when included by the library itself the header must declare the
8313 variables and functions as dllexport, but when included by client
8314 code the header must declare them as dllimport. There are a number
8315 of idioms that are typically used to do this; often client code can
8316 omit the __declspec() declaration completely. See
8317 @samp{--enable-auto-import} and @samp{automatic data imports} for more
8318 information.
8319 @end table
8320
8321 @cindex automatic data imports
8322 @item automatic data imports
8323 The standard Windows dll format supports data imports from dlls only
8324 by adding special decorations (dllimport/dllexport), which let the
8325 compiler produce specific assembler instructions to deal with this
8326 issue. This increases the effort necessary to port existing Un*x
8327 code to these platforms, especially for large
8328 c++ libraries and applications. The auto-import feature, which was
8329 initially provided by Paul Sokolovsky, allows one to omit the
8330 decorations to achieve a behavior that conforms to that on POSIX/Un*x
8331 platforms. This feature is enabled with the @samp{--enable-auto-import}
8332 command-line option, although it is enabled by default on cygwin/mingw.
8333 The @samp{--enable-auto-import} option itself now serves mainly to
8334 suppress any warnings that are ordinarily emitted when linked objects
8335 trigger the feature's use.
8336
8337 auto-import of variables does not always work flawlessly without
8338 additional assistance. Sometimes, you will see this message
8339
8340 "variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
8341 documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
8342
8343 The @samp{--enable-auto-import} documentation explains why this error
8344 occurs, and several methods that can be used to overcome this difficulty.
8345 One of these methods is the @emph{runtime pseudo-relocs} feature, described
8346 below.
8347
8348 @cindex runtime pseudo-relocation
8349 For complex variables imported from DLLs (such as structs or classes),
8350 object files typically contain a base address for the variable and an
8351 offset (@emph{addend}) within the variable--to specify a particular
8352 field or public member, for instance. Unfortunately, the runtime loader used
8353 in win32 environments is incapable of fixing these references at runtime
8354 without the additional information supplied by dllimport/dllexport decorations.
8355 The standard auto-import feature described above is unable to resolve these
8356 references.
8357
8358 The @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} switch allows these references to
8359 be resolved without error, while leaving the task of adjusting the references
8360 themselves (with their non-zero addends) to specialized code provided by the
8361 runtime environment. Recent versions of the cygwin and mingw environments and
8362 compilers provide this runtime support; older versions do not. However, the
8363 support is only necessary on the developer's platform; the compiled result will
8364 run without error on an older system.
8365
8366 @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is not the default; it must be explicitly
8367 enabled as needed.
8368
8369 @cindex direct linking to a dll
8370 @item direct linking to a dll
8371 The cygwin/mingw ports of @command{ld} support the direct linking,
8372 including data symbols, to a dll without the usage of any import
8373 libraries. This is much faster and uses much less memory than does the
8374 traditional import library method, especially when linking large
8375 libraries or applications. When @command{ld} creates an import lib, each
8376 function or variable exported from the dll is stored in its own bfd, even
8377 though a single bfd could contain many exports. The overhead involved in
8378 storing, loading, and processing so many bfd's is quite large, and explains the
8379 tremendous time, memory, and storage needed to link against particularly
8380 large or complex libraries when using import libs.
8381
8382 Linking directly to a dll uses no extra command-line switches other than
8383 @samp{-L} and @samp{-l}, because @command{ld} already searches for a number
8384 of names to match each library. All that is needed from the developer's
8385 perspective is an understanding of this search, in order to force ld to
8386 select the dll instead of an import library.
8387
8388
8389 For instance, when ld is called with the argument @samp{-lxxx} it will attempt
8390 to find, in the first directory of its search path,
8391
8392 @example
8393 libxxx.dll.a
8394 xxx.dll.a
8395 libxxx.a
8396 xxx.lib
8397 libxxx.lib
8398 cygxxx.dll (*)
8399 libxxx.dll
8400 xxx.dll
8401 @end example
8402
8403 before moving on to the next directory in the search path.
8404
8405 (*) Actually, this is not @samp{cygxxx.dll} but in fact is @samp{<prefix>xxx.dll},
8406 where @samp{<prefix>} is set by the @command{ld} option
8407 @samp{--dll-search-prefix=<prefix>}. In the case of cygwin, the standard gcc spec
8408 file includes @samp{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}, so in effect we actually search for
8409 @samp{cygxxx.dll}.
8410
8411 Other win32-based unix environments, such as mingw or pw32, may use other
8412 @samp{<prefix>}es, although at present only cygwin makes use of this feature. It
8413 was originally intended to help avoid name conflicts among dll's built for the
8414 various win32/un*x environments, so that (for example) two versions of a zlib dll
8415 could coexist on the same machine.
8416
8417 The generic cygwin/mingw path layout uses a @samp{bin} directory for
8418 applications and dll's and a @samp{lib} directory for the import
8419 libraries (using cygwin nomenclature):
8420
8421 @example
8422 bin/
8423 cygxxx.dll
8424 lib/
8425 libxxx.dll.a (in case of dll's)
8426 libxxx.a (in case of static archive)
8427 @end example
8428
8429 Linking directly to a dll without using the import library can be
8430 done two ways:
8431
8432 1. Use the dll directly by adding the @samp{bin} path to the link line
8433 @example
8434 gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../bin/ -lxxx
8435 @end example
8436
8437 However, as the dll's often have version numbers appended to their names
8438 (@samp{cygncurses-5.dll}) this will often fail, unless one specifies
8439 @samp{-L../bin -lncurses-5} to include the version. Import libs are generally
8440 not versioned, and do not have this difficulty.
8441
8442 2. Create a symbolic link from the dll to a file in the @samp{lib}
8443 directory according to the above mentioned search pattern. This
8444 should be used to avoid unwanted changes in the tools needed for
8445 making the app/dll.
8446
8447 @example
8448 ln -s bin/cygxxx.dll lib/[cyg|lib|]xxx.dll[.a]
8449 @end example
8450
8451 Then you can link without any make environment changes.
8452
8453 @example
8454 gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../lib/ -lxxx
8455 @end example
8456
8457 This technique also avoids the version number problems, because the following is
8458 perfectly legal
8459
8460 @example
8461 bin/
8462 cygxxx-5.dll
8463 lib/
8464 libxxx.dll.a -> ../bin/cygxxx-5.dll
8465 @end example
8466
8467 Linking directly to a dll without using an import lib will work
8468 even when auto-import features are exercised, and even when
8469 @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is used.
8470
8471 Given the improvements in speed and memory usage, one might justifiably
8472 wonder why import libraries are used at all. There are three reasons:
8473
8474 1. Until recently, the link-directly-to-dll functionality did @emph{not}
8475 work with auto-imported data.
8476
8477 2. Sometimes it is necessary to include pure static objects within the
8478 import library (which otherwise contains only bfd's for indirection
8479 symbols that point to the exports of a dll). Again, the import lib
8480 for the cygwin kernel makes use of this ability, and it is not
8481 possible to do this without an import lib.
8482
8483 3. Symbol aliases can only be resolved using an import lib. This is
8484 critical when linking against OS-supplied dll's (eg, the win32 API)
8485 in which symbols are usually exported as undecorated aliases of their
8486 stdcall-decorated assembly names.
8487
8488 So, import libs are not going away. But the ability to replace
8489 true import libs with a simple symbolic link to (or a copy of)
8490 a dll, in many cases, is a useful addition to the suite of tools
8491 binutils makes available to the win32 developer. Given the
8492 massive improvements in memory requirements during linking, storage
8493 requirements, and linking speed, we expect that many developers
8494 will soon begin to use this feature whenever possible.
8495
8496 @item symbol aliasing
8497 @table @emph
8498 @item adding additional names
8499 Sometimes, it is useful to export symbols with additional names.
8500 A symbol @samp{foo} will be exported as @samp{foo}, but it can also be
8501 exported as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the DEF file
8502 when creating the dll. This will affect also the optional created
8503 import library. Consider the following DEF file:
8504
8505 @example
8506 LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8507
8508 EXPORTS
8509 foo
8510 _foo = foo
8511 @end example
8512
8513 The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the symbol @samp{foo} to @samp{_foo}.
8514
8515 Another method for creating a symbol alias is to create it in the
8516 source code using the "weak" attribute:
8517
8518 @example
8519 void foo () @{ /* Do something. */; @}
8520 void _foo () __attribute__ ((weak, alias ("foo")));
8521 @end example
8522
8523 See the gcc manual for more information about attributes and weak
8524 symbols.
8525
8526 @item renaming symbols
8527 Sometimes it is useful to rename exports. For instance, the cygwin
8528 kernel does this regularly. A symbol @samp{_foo} can be exported as
8529 @samp{foo} but not as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the
8530 DEF file. (This will also affect the import library, if it is
8531 created). In the following example:
8532
8533 @example
8534 LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8535
8536 EXPORTS
8537 _foo = foo
8538 @end example
8539
8540 The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the exported symbol @samp{foo} to
8541 @samp{_foo}.
8542 @end table
8543
8544 Note: using a DEF file disables the default auto-export behavior,
8545 unless the @samp{--export-all-symbols} command-line option is used.
8546 If, however, you are trying to rename symbols, then you should list
8547 @emph{all} desired exports in the DEF file, including the symbols
8548 that are not being renamed, and do @emph{not} use the
8549 @samp{--export-all-symbols} option. If you list only the
8550 renamed symbols in the DEF file, and use @samp{--export-all-symbols}
8551 to handle the other symbols, then the both the new names @emph{and}
8552 the original names for the renamed symbols will be exported.
8553 In effect, you'd be aliasing those symbols, not renaming them,
8554 which is probably not what you wanted.
8555
8556 @cindex weak externals
8557 @item weak externals
8558 The Windows object format, PE, specifies a form of weak symbols called
8559 weak externals. When a weak symbol is linked and the symbol is not
8560 defined, the weak symbol becomes an alias for some other symbol. There
8561 are three variants of weak externals:
8562 @itemize
8563 @item Definition is searched for in objects and libraries, historically
8564 called lazy externals.
8565 @item Definition is searched for only in other objects, not in libraries.
8566 This form is not presently implemented.
8567 @item No search; the symbol is an alias. This form is not presently
8568 implemented.
8569 @end itemize
8570 As a GNU extension, weak symbols that do not specify an alternate symbol
8571 are supported. If the symbol is undefined when linking, the symbol
8572 uses a default value.
8573
8574 @cindex aligned common symbols
8575 @item aligned common symbols
8576 As a GNU extension to the PE file format, it is possible to specify the
8577 desired alignment for a common symbol. This information is conveyed from
8578 the assembler or compiler to the linker by means of GNU-specific commands
8579 carried in the object file's @samp{.drectve} section, which are recognized
8580 by @command{ld} and respected when laying out the common symbols. Native
8581 tools will be able to process object files employing this GNU extension,
8582 but will fail to respect the alignment instructions, and may issue noisy
8583 warnings about unknown linker directives.
8584
8585 @end table
8586
8587 @ifclear GENERIC
8588 @lowersections
8589 @end ifclear
8590 @end ifset
8591
8592 @ifset XTENSA
8593 @ifclear GENERIC
8594 @raisesections
8595 @end ifclear
8596
8597 @node Xtensa
8598 @section @code{ld} and Xtensa Processors
8599
8600 @cindex Xtensa processors
8601 The default @command{ld} behavior for Xtensa processors is to interpret
8602 @code{SECTIONS} commands so that lists of explicitly named sections in a
8603 specification with a wildcard file will be interleaved when necessary to
8604 keep literal pools within the range of PC-relative load offsets. For
8605 example, with the command:
8606
8607 @smallexample
8608 SECTIONS
8609 @{
8610 .text : @{
8611 *(.literal .text)
8612 @}
8613 @}
8614 @end smallexample
8615
8616 @noindent
8617 @command{ld} may interleave some of the @code{.literal}
8618 and @code{.text} sections from different object files to ensure that the
8619 literal pools are within the range of PC-relative load offsets. A valid
8620 interleaving might place the @code{.literal} sections from an initial
8621 group of files followed by the @code{.text} sections of that group of
8622 files. Then, the @code{.literal} sections from the rest of the files
8623 and the @code{.text} sections from the rest of the files would follow.
8624
8625 @cindex @option{--relax} on Xtensa
8626 @cindex relaxing on Xtensa
8627 Relaxation is enabled by default for the Xtensa version of @command{ld} and
8628 provides two important link-time optimizations. The first optimization
8629 is to combine identical literal values to reduce code size. A redundant
8630 literal will be removed and all the @code{L32R} instructions that use it
8631 will be changed to reference an identical literal, as long as the
8632 location of the replacement literal is within the offset range of all
8633 the @code{L32R} instructions. The second optimization is to remove
8634 unnecessary overhead from assembler-generated ``longcall'' sequences of
8635 @code{L32R}/@code{CALLX@var{n}} when the target functions are within
8636 range of direct @code{CALL@var{n}} instructions.
8637
8638 For each of these cases where an indirect call sequence can be optimized
8639 to a direct call, the linker will change the @code{CALLX@var{n}}
8640 instruction to a @code{CALL@var{n}} instruction, remove the @code{L32R}
8641 instruction, and remove the literal referenced by the @code{L32R}
8642 instruction if it is not used for anything else. Removing the
8643 @code{L32R} instruction always reduces code size but can potentially
8644 hurt performance by changing the alignment of subsequent branch targets.
8645 By default, the linker will always preserve alignments, either by
8646 switching some instructions between 24-bit encodings and the equivalent
8647 density instructions or by inserting a no-op in place of the @code{L32R}
8648 instruction that was removed. If code size is more important than
8649 performance, the @option{--size-opt} option can be used to prevent the
8650 linker from widening density instructions or inserting no-ops, except in
8651 a few cases where no-ops are required for correctness.
8652
8653 The following Xtensa-specific command-line options can be used to
8654 control the linker:
8655
8656 @cindex Xtensa options
8657 @table @option
8658 @item --size-opt
8659 When optimizing indirect calls to direct calls, optimize for code size
8660 more than performance. With this option, the linker will not insert
8661 no-ops or widen density instructions to preserve branch target
8662 alignment. There may still be some cases where no-ops are required to
8663 preserve the correctness of the code.
8664
8665 @item --abi-windowed
8666 @itemx --abi-call0
8667 Choose ABI for the output object and for the generated PLT code.
8668 PLT code inserted by the linker must match ABI of the output object
8669 because windowed and call0 ABI use incompatible function call
8670 conventions.
8671 Default ABI is chosen by the ABI tag in the @code{.xtensa.info} section
8672 of the first input object.
8673 A warning is issued if ABI tags of input objects do not match each other
8674 or the chosen output object ABI.
8675 @end table
8676
8677 @ifclear GENERIC
8678 @lowersections
8679 @end ifclear
8680 @end ifset
8681
8682 @ifclear SingleFormat
8683 @node BFD
8684 @chapter BFD
8685
8686 @cindex back end
8687 @cindex object file management
8688 @cindex object formats available
8689 @kindex objdump -i
8690 The linker accesses object and archive files using the BFD libraries.
8691 These libraries allow the linker to use the same routines to operate on
8692 object files whatever the object file format. A different object file
8693 format can be supported simply by creating a new BFD back end and adding
8694 it to the library. To conserve runtime memory, however, the linker and
8695 associated tools are usually configured to support only a subset of the
8696 object file formats available. You can use @code{objdump -i}
8697 (@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils.info,The GNU Binary Utilities}) to
8698 list all the formats available for your configuration.
8699
8700 @cindex BFD requirements
8701 @cindex requirements for BFD
8702 As with most implementations, BFD is a compromise between
8703 several conflicting requirements. The major factor influencing
8704 BFD design was efficiency: any time used converting between
8705 formats is time which would not have been spent had BFD not
8706 been involved. This is partly offset by abstraction payback; since
8707 BFD simplifies applications and back ends, more time and care
8708 may be spent optimizing algorithms for a greater speed.
8709
8710 One minor artifact of the BFD solution which you should bear in
8711 mind is the potential for information loss. There are two places where
8712 useful information can be lost using the BFD mechanism: during
8713 conversion and during output. @xref{BFD information loss}.
8714
8715 @menu
8716 * BFD outline:: How it works: an outline of BFD
8717 @end menu
8718
8719 @node BFD outline
8720 @section How It Works: An Outline of BFD
8721 @cindex opening object files
8722 @include bfdsumm.texi
8723 @end ifclear
8724
8725 @node Reporting Bugs
8726 @chapter Reporting Bugs
8727 @cindex bugs in @command{ld}
8728 @cindex reporting bugs in @command{ld}
8729
8730 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @command{ld} reliable.
8731
8732 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or
8733 it may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is
8734 to help the entire community by making the next version of @command{ld}
8735 work better. Bug reports are your contribution to the maintenance of
8736 @command{ld}.
8737
8738 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
8739 information that enables us to fix the bug.
8740
8741 @menu
8742 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
8743 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
8744 @end menu
8745
8746 @node Bug Criteria
8747 @section Have You Found a Bug?
8748 @cindex bug criteria
8749
8750 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
8751
8752 @itemize @bullet
8753 @cindex fatal signal
8754 @cindex linker crash
8755 @cindex crash of linker
8756 @item
8757 If the linker gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
8758 @command{ld} bug. Reliable linkers never crash.
8759
8760 @cindex error on valid input
8761 @item
8762 If @command{ld} produces an error message for valid input, that is a bug.
8763
8764 @cindex invalid input
8765 @item
8766 If @command{ld} does not produce an error message for invalid input, that
8767 may be a bug. In the general case, the linker can not verify that
8768 object files are correct.
8769
8770 @item
8771 If you are an experienced user of linkers, your suggestions for
8772 improvement of @command{ld} are welcome in any case.
8773 @end itemize
8774
8775 @node Bug Reporting
8776 @section How to Report Bugs
8777 @cindex bug reports
8778 @cindex @command{ld} bugs, reporting
8779
8780 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu}
8781 products. If you obtained @command{ld} from a support organization, we
8782 recommend you contact that organization first.
8783
8784 You can find contact information for many support companies and
8785 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
8786 distribution.
8787
8788 @ifset BUGURL
8789 Otherwise, send bug reports for @command{ld} to
8790 @value{BUGURL}.
8791 @end ifset
8792
8793 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
8794 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
8795 fact or leave it out, state it!
8796
8797 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
8798 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
8799 assume that the name of a symbol you use in an example does not
8800 matter. Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps
8801 the bug is a stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the
8802 location where that name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name
8803 were different, the contents of that location would fool the linker
8804 into doing the right thing despite the bug. Play it safe and give a
8805 specific, complete example. That is the easiest thing for you to do,
8806 and the most helpful.
8807
8808 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix
8809 the bug if it is new to us. Therefore, always write your bug reports
8810 on the assumption that the bug has not been reported previously.
8811
8812 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
8813 bell?'' This cannot help us fix a bug, so it is basically useless. We
8814 respond by asking for enough details to enable us to investigate.
8815 You might as well expedite matters by sending them to begin with.
8816
8817 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
8818
8819 @itemize @bullet
8820 @item
8821 The version of @command{ld}. @command{ld} announces it if you start it with
8822 the @samp{--version} argument.
8823
8824 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
8825 the bug in the current version of @command{ld}.
8826
8827 @item
8828 Any patches you may have applied to the @command{ld} source, including any
8829 patches made to the @code{BFD} library.
8830
8831 @item
8832 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
8833 version number.
8834
8835 @item
8836 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @command{ld}---e.g.
8837 ``@code{gcc-2.7}''.
8838
8839 @item
8840 The command arguments you gave the linker to link your example and
8841 observe the bug. To guarantee you will not omit something important,
8842 list them all. A copy of the Makefile (or the output from make) is
8843 sufficient.
8844
8845 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
8846 and then we might not encounter the bug.
8847
8848 @item
8849 A complete input file, or set of input files, that will reproduce the
8850 bug. It is generally most helpful to send the actual object files
8851 provided that they are reasonably small. Say no more than 10K. For
8852 bigger files you can either make them available by FTP or HTTP or else
8853 state that you are willing to send the object file(s) to whomever
8854 requests them. (Note - your email will be going to a mailing list, so
8855 we do not want to clog it up with large attachments). But small
8856 attachments are best.
8857
8858 If the source files were assembled using @code{gas} or compiled using
8859 @code{gcc}, then it may be OK to send the source files rather than the
8860 object files. In this case, be sure to say exactly what version of
8861 @code{gas} or @code{gcc} was used to produce the object files. Also say
8862 how @code{gas} or @code{gcc} were configured.
8863
8864 @item
8865 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
8866 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
8867
8868 Of course, if the bug is that @command{ld} gets a fatal signal, then we
8869 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
8870 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
8871 a chance to make a mistake.
8872
8873 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
8874 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
8875 copy of @command{ld} is out of sync, or you have encountered a bug in the
8876 C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might crash
8877 and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when ours
8878 fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for us. If
8879 you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able to draw
8880 any conclusion from our observations.
8881
8882 @item
8883 If you wish to suggest changes to the @command{ld} source, send us context
8884 diffs, as generated by @code{diff} with the @samp{-u}, @samp{-c}, or
8885 @samp{-p} option. Always send diffs from the old file to the new file.
8886 If you even discuss something in the @command{ld} source, refer to it by
8887 context, not by line number.
8888
8889 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
8890 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
8891 @end itemize
8892
8893 Here are some things that are not necessary:
8894
8895 @itemize @bullet
8896 @item
8897 A description of the envelope of the bug.
8898
8899 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
8900 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
8901 changes will not affect it.
8902
8903 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
8904 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
8905 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
8906 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
8907
8908 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
8909 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
8910 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
8911 less time, and so on.
8912
8913 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
8914 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
8915
8916 @item
8917 A patch for the bug.
8918
8919 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
8920 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
8921 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
8922 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
8923
8924 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @command{ld} it is very hard to
8925 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
8926 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be
8927 able to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is
8928 fixed.
8929
8930 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
8931 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
8932 help us to understand.
8933
8934 @item
8935 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
8936
8937 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
8938 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
8939 @end itemize
8940
8941 @node MRI
8942 @appendix MRI Compatible Script Files
8943 @cindex MRI compatibility
8944 To aid users making the transition to @sc{gnu} @command{ld} from the MRI
8945 linker, @command{ld} can use MRI compatible linker scripts as an
8946 alternative to the more general-purpose linker scripting language
8947 described in @ref{Scripts}. MRI compatible linker scripts have a much
8948 simpler command set than the scripting language otherwise used with
8949 @command{ld}. @sc{gnu} @command{ld} supports the most commonly used MRI
8950 linker commands; these commands are described here.
8951
8952 In general, MRI scripts aren't of much use with the @code{a.out} object
8953 file format, since it only has three sections and MRI scripts lack some
8954 features to make use of them.
8955
8956 You can specify a file containing an MRI-compatible script using the
8957 @samp{-c} command-line option.
8958
8959 Each command in an MRI-compatible script occupies its own line; each
8960 command line starts with the keyword that identifies the command (though
8961 blank lines are also allowed for punctuation). If a line of an
8962 MRI-compatible script begins with an unrecognized keyword, @command{ld}
8963 issues a warning message, but continues processing the script.
8964
8965 Lines beginning with @samp{*} are comments.
8966
8967 You can write these commands using all upper-case letters, or all
8968 lower case; for example, @samp{chip} is the same as @samp{CHIP}.
8969 The following list shows only the upper-case form of each command.
8970
8971 @table @code
8972 @cindex @code{ABSOLUTE} (MRI)
8973 @item ABSOLUTE @var{secname}
8974 @itemx ABSOLUTE @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
8975 Normally, @command{ld} includes in the output file all sections from all
8976 the input files. However, in an MRI-compatible script, you can use the
8977 @code{ABSOLUTE} command to restrict the sections that will be present in
8978 your output program. If the @code{ABSOLUTE} command is used at all in a
8979 script, then only the sections named explicitly in @code{ABSOLUTE}
8980 commands will appear in the linker output. You can still use other
8981 input sections (whatever you select on the command line, or using
8982 @code{LOAD}) to resolve addresses in the output file.
8983
8984 @cindex @code{ALIAS} (MRI)
8985 @item ALIAS @var{out-secname}, @var{in-secname}
8986 Use this command to place the data from input section @var{in-secname}
8987 in a section called @var{out-secname} in the linker output file.
8988
8989 @var{in-secname} may be an integer.
8990
8991 @cindex @code{ALIGN} (MRI)
8992 @item ALIGN @var{secname} = @var{expression}
8993 Align the section called @var{secname} to @var{expression}. The
8994 @var{expression} should be a power of two.
8995
8996 @cindex @code{BASE} (MRI)
8997 @item BASE @var{expression}
8998 Use the value of @var{expression} as the lowest address (other than
8999 absolute addresses) in the output file.
9000
9001 @cindex @code{CHIP} (MRI)
9002 @item CHIP @var{expression}
9003 @itemx CHIP @var{expression}, @var{expression}
9004 This command does nothing; it is accepted only for compatibility.
9005
9006 @cindex @code{END} (MRI)
9007 @item END
9008 This command does nothing whatever; it's only accepted for compatibility.
9009
9010 @cindex @code{FORMAT} (MRI)
9011 @item FORMAT @var{output-format}
9012 Similar to the @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command in the more general linker
9013 language, but restricted to S-records, if @var{output-format} is @samp{S}
9014
9015 @cindex @code{LIST} (MRI)
9016 @item LIST @var{anything}@dots{}
9017 Print (to the standard output file) a link map, as produced by the
9018 @command{ld} command-line option @samp{-M}.
9019
9020 The keyword @code{LIST} may be followed by anything on the
9021 same line, with no change in its effect.
9022
9023 @cindex @code{LOAD} (MRI)
9024 @item LOAD @var{filename}
9025 @itemx LOAD @var{filename}, @var{filename}, @dots{} @var{filename}
9026 Include one or more object file @var{filename} in the link; this has the
9027 same effect as specifying @var{filename} directly on the @command{ld}
9028 command line.
9029
9030 @cindex @code{NAME} (MRI)
9031 @item NAME @var{output-name}
9032 @var{output-name} is the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; the
9033 MRI-compatible command @code{NAME} is equivalent to the command-line
9034 option @samp{-o} or the general script language command @code{OUTPUT}.
9035
9036 @cindex @code{ORDER} (MRI)
9037 @item ORDER @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
9038 @itemx ORDER @var{secname} @var{secname} @var{secname}
9039 Normally, @command{ld} orders the sections in its output file in the
9040 order in which they first appear in the input files. In an MRI-compatible
9041 script, you can override this ordering with the @code{ORDER} command. The
9042 sections you list with @code{ORDER} will appear first in your output
9043 file, in the order specified.
9044
9045 @cindex @code{PUBLIC} (MRI)
9046 @item PUBLIC @var{name}=@var{expression}
9047 @itemx PUBLIC @var{name},@var{expression}
9048 @itemx PUBLIC @var{name} @var{expression}
9049 Supply a value (@var{expression}) for external symbol
9050 @var{name} used in the linker input files.
9051
9052 @cindex @code{SECT} (MRI)
9053 @item SECT @var{secname}, @var{expression}
9054 @itemx SECT @var{secname}=@var{expression}
9055 @itemx SECT @var{secname} @var{expression}
9056 You can use any of these three forms of the @code{SECT} command to
9057 specify the start address (@var{expression}) for section @var{secname}.
9058 If you have more than one @code{SECT} statement for the same
9059 @var{secname}, only the @emph{first} sets the start address.
9060 @end table
9061
9062 @node GNU Free Documentation License
9063 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
9064 @include fdl.texi
9065
9066 @node LD Index
9067 @unnumbered LD Index
9068
9069 @printindex cp
9070
9071 @tex
9072 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
9073 % meantime:
9074 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
9075 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
9076 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
9077 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
9078 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
9079 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/} and}
9080 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
9081 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
9082 \page\colophon
9083 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 28mar91.
9084 @end tex
9085
9086 @bye